]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - gdb/breakpoint.c
Simplify MI breakpoint setting.
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include "arch-utils.h"
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include "hashtab.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "frame.h"
28 #include "breakpoint.h"
29 #include "tracepoint.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "expression.h"
32 #include "gdbcore.h"
33 #include "gdbcmd.h"
34 #include "value.h"
35 #include "command.h"
36 #include "inferior.h"
37 #include "gdbthread.h"
38 #include "target.h"
39 #include "language.h"
40 #include "gdb_string.h"
41 #include "demangle.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "wrapper.h"
61 #include "valprint.h"
62 #include "jit.h"
63 #include "xml-syscall.h"
64
65 /* readline include files */
66 #include "readline/readline.h"
67 #include "readline/history.h"
68
69 /* readline defines this. */
70 #undef savestring
71
72 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
73
74 /* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
75 #define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
76 #define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
77
78 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
79
80 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
81
82 static void enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
83
84 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
85
86 static void enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *);
87
88 static void disable_command (char *, int);
89
90 static void enable_command (char *, int);
91
92 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*)(struct breakpoint *));
93
94 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
95
96 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
97
98 static void clear_command (char *, int);
99
100 static void catch_command (char *, int);
101
102 static void watch_command (char *, int);
103
104 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
105
106 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
107
108 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
109
110 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
111 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
112 struct symtab_and_line,
113 enum bptype);
114
115 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
116
117 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
118 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
119 enum bptype bptype);
120
121 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
122 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
123 struct obj_section *, int);
124
125 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
126 CORE_ADDR addr1,
127 struct address_space *aspace2,
128 CORE_ADDR addr2);
129
130 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
131 struct bp_location *loc2);
132
133 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
134
135 static void breakpoint_1 (int, int);
136
137 static bpstat bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *, bpstat);
138
139 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
140
141 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
142
143 static void commands_command (char *, int);
144
145 static void condition_command (char *, int);
146
147 static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
148
149 void set_breakpoint_count (int);
150
151 typedef enum
152 {
153 mark_inserted,
154 mark_uninserted
155 }
156 insertion_state_t;
157
158 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
159 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
160
161 static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
162
163 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
164
165 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
166
167 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
168
169 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
170
171 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
172
173 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
174
175 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
176
177 static void watch_command_1 (char *, int, int);
178
179 static void rwatch_command (char *, int);
180
181 static void awatch_command (char *, int);
182
183 static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
184
185 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
186
187 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
188
189 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
190
191 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
192
193 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
194 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
195
196 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
197
198 static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
199
200 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
201 CORE_ADDR pc);
202
203 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
204
205 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
206
207 static void update_global_location_list (int);
208
209 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
210
211 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
212
213 static int is_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt);
214
215 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
216
217 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
218
219 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
220
221 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
222
223 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
224
225 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
226
227 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
228
229 static void skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal);
230
231
232 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
233 current breakpoint. */
234
235 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
236
237 static const char *
238 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
239 {
240 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and represent
241 values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at a breakpoint. */
242 static char *bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
243 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
244 }
245
246 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
247 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
248 if such is available. */
249 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
250
251 static void
252 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
253 struct cmd_list_element *c,
254 const char *value)
255 {
256 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
257 Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
258 value);
259 }
260
261 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
262 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
263 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
264 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
265 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
266 static void
267 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
268 struct cmd_list_element *c,
269 const char *value)
270 {
271 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
272 Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
273 value);
274 }
275
276 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
277 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
278 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
279 use hardware breakpoints. */
280 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
281 static void
282 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
283 struct cmd_list_element *c,
284 const char *value)
285 {
286 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
287 Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
288 value);
289 }
290
291 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
292 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
293 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
294 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
295 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
296
297 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
298 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
299 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
300 static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
301 always_inserted_auto,
302 always_inserted_off,
303 always_inserted_on,
304 NULL
305 };
306 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
307 static void
308 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
309 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
310 {
311 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
312 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
313 Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
314 value,
315 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
316 else
317 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
318 }
319
320 int
321 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
322 {
323 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
324 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
325 }
326
327 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
328
329 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
330 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
331
332 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
333 static int overlay_events_enabled;
334
335 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
336 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the current
337 breakpoint. */
338
339 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
340
341 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
342 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
343 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
344 B = TMP)
345
346 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is not
347 provided so update_global_location_list must not be called while executing
348 the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
349
350 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
351 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
352 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
353 BP_TMP++)
354
355 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
356
357 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
358 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
359 if (tracepoint_type (B))
360
361 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
362
363 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
364
365 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
366
367 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
368
369 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
370
371 static unsigned bp_location_count;
372
373 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and ADDRESS
374 for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
375 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
376 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
377
378 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
379
380 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between
381 bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for
382 the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from
383 bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of
384 BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
385
386 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
387
388 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint,
389 unlinked from bp_location array, but for which a hit
390 may still be reported by a target. */
391 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
392
393 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
394
395 int breakpoint_count;
396
397 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
398
399 int tracepoint_count;
400
401 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
402 static int
403 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
404 {
405 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
406 }
407
408 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
409
410 void
411 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
412 {
413 breakpoint_count = num;
414 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
415 }
416
417 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
418
419 void
420 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
421 {
422 struct breakpoint *b;
423
424 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
425 b->hit_count = 0;
426 }
427
428 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
429
430 static int
431 tracepoint_type (const struct breakpoint *b)
432 {
433 return (b->type == bp_tracepoint || b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint);
434 }
435
436 /* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
437 for "break" command with no arg.
438 if default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
439 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
440
441 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
442
443 int default_breakpoint_valid;
444 CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
445 struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
446 int default_breakpoint_line;
447 struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
448
449 \f
450 /* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint. Get the number of the breakpoint.
451 Advance *PP after the string and any trailing whitespace.
452
453 Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the name
454 of a convenience variable. Making it an expression wouldn't work well
455 for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
456
457 If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
458
459 TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
460 commonly this is `-'. If you don't want a trailer, use \0. */
461 static int
462 get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
463 {
464 int retval = 0; /* default */
465 char *p = *pp;
466
467 if (p == NULL)
468 /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint. */
469 return breakpoint_count;
470 else if (*p == '$')
471 {
472 /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
473 to pass to lookup_internalvar(). */
474 char *varname;
475 char *start = ++p;
476 LONGEST val;
477
478 while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
479 p++;
480 varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
481 strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
482 varname[p - start] = '\0';
483 if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
484 retval = (int) val;
485 else
486 {
487 printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
488 retval = 0;
489 }
490 }
491 else
492 {
493 if (*p == '-')
494 ++p;
495 while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
496 ++p;
497 if (p == *pp)
498 /* There is no number here. (e.g. "cond a == b"). */
499 {
500 /* Skip non-numeric token */
501 while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
502 ++p;
503 /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
504 retval = 0;
505 }
506 else
507 retval = atoi (*pp);
508 }
509 if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
510 {
511 /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
512 while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
513 ++p;
514 retval = 0;
515 }
516 while (isspace (*p))
517 p++;
518 *pp = p;
519 return retval;
520 }
521
522
523 /* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer. */
524 int
525 get_number (char **pp)
526 {
527 return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
528 }
529
530 /* Parse a number or a range.
531 * A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
532 * A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
533 * will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
534 * inclusive.
535 *
536 * While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
537 * At each call it will return the next value in the range.
538 *
539 * At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
540 * be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
541 * Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
542 * is completed. The call that completes the range will advance
543 * pointer PP past <number2>.
544 */
545
546 int
547 get_number_or_range (char **pp)
548 {
549 static int last_retval, end_value;
550 static char *end_ptr;
551 static int in_range = 0;
552
553 if (**pp != '-')
554 {
555 /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
556 or to the first number of a range. */
557 last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
558 if (**pp == '-')
559 {
560 char **temp;
561
562 /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
563 Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
564 and also remember the end of the final token. */
565
566 temp = &end_ptr;
567 end_ptr = *pp + 1;
568 while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
569 end_ptr++; /* skip white space */
570 end_value = get_number (temp);
571 if (end_value < last_retval)
572 {
573 error (_("inverted range"));
574 }
575 else if (end_value == last_retval)
576 {
577 /* degenerate range (number1 == number2). Advance the
578 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
579 single number. */
580 *pp = end_ptr;
581 }
582 else
583 in_range = 1;
584 }
585 }
586 else if (! in_range)
587 error (_("negative value"));
588 else
589 {
590 /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range. All
591 number-parsing has already been done. Return the next
592 integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
593 Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
594 is reached. */
595
596 if (++last_retval == end_value)
597 {
598 /* End of range reached; advance token pointer. */
599 *pp = end_ptr;
600 in_range = 0;
601 }
602 }
603 return last_retval;
604 }
605
606 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
607 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
608
609 struct breakpoint *
610 get_breakpoint (int num)
611 {
612 struct breakpoint *b;
613
614 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
615 if (b->number == num)
616 return b;
617
618 return NULL;
619 }
620
621 \f
622 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
623
624 static void
625 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
626 {
627 struct breakpoint *b;
628 char *p;
629 int bnum;
630
631 if (arg == 0)
632 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
633
634 p = arg;
635 bnum = get_number (&p);
636 if (bnum == 0)
637 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
638
639 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
640 if (b->number == bnum)
641 {
642 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
643 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
644 {
645 xfree (loc->cond);
646 loc->cond = NULL;
647 }
648 xfree (b->cond_string);
649 b->cond_string = NULL;
650 xfree (b->cond_exp);
651 b->cond_exp = NULL;
652
653 if (*p == 0)
654 {
655 if (from_tty)
656 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), bnum);
657 }
658 else
659 {
660 arg = p;
661 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
662 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
663 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
664 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
665
666 if (is_watchpoint (b))
667 {
668 innermost_block = NULL;
669 arg = p;
670 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
671 if (*arg)
672 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
673 b->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
674 }
675 else
676 {
677 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
678 {
679 arg = p;
680 loc->cond =
681 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
682 if (*arg)
683 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
684 }
685 }
686 }
687 breakpoints_changed ();
688 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
689 return;
690 }
691
692 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
693 }
694
695 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. */
696
697 void
698 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, struct command_line *commands)
699 {
700 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
701 b->commands = commands;
702 breakpoints_changed ();
703 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
704 }
705
706 static void
707 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
708 {
709 struct breakpoint *b;
710 char *p;
711 int bnum;
712 struct command_line *l;
713
714 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
715 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
716 being read from. */
717
718 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
719 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
720
721 p = arg;
722 bnum = get_number (&p);
723
724 if (p && *p)
725 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
726
727 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
728 if (b->number == bnum)
729 {
730 char *tmpbuf = xstrprintf ("Type commands for when breakpoint %d is hit, one per line.",
731 bnum);
732 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, tmpbuf);
733 l = read_command_lines (tmpbuf, from_tty, 1);
734 do_cleanups (cleanups);
735 breakpoint_set_commands (b, l);
736 return;
737 }
738 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
739 }
740
741 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
742 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
743
744 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
745 that are part of if and while bodies. */
746 enum command_control_type
747 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
748 {
749 struct breakpoint *b;
750 char *p;
751 int bnum;
752
753 /* If we allowed this, we would have problems with when to
754 free the storage, if we change the commands currently
755 being read from. */
756
757 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
758 error (_("Can't use the \"commands\" command among a breakpoint's commands."));
759
760 /* An empty string for the breakpoint number means the last
761 breakpoint, but get_number expects a NULL pointer. */
762 if (arg && !*arg)
763 p = NULL;
764 else
765 p = arg;
766 bnum = get_number (&p);
767
768 if (p && *p)
769 error (_("Unexpected extra arguments following breakpoint number."));
770
771 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
772 if (b->number == bnum)
773 {
774 free_command_lines (&b->commands);
775 if (cmd->body_count != 1)
776 error (_("Invalid \"commands\" block structure."));
777 /* We need to copy the commands because if/while will free the
778 list after it finishes execution. */
779 b->commands = copy_command_lines (cmd->body_list[0]);
780 breakpoints_changed ();
781 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
782 return simple_control;
783 }
784 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
785 }
786
787 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
788
789 static int
790 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
791 {
792 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
793 return 0;
794 if (!bl->inserted)
795 return 0;
796 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
797 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
798 return 0;
799 return 1;
800 }
801
802 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
803 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
804
805 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
806 b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
807 up to b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
808 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
809 memaddr ... memaddr + len
810 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
811 memaddr + len <= b->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
812 and:
813 b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
814
815 void
816 breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
817 {
818 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary search. */
819 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
820
821 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF content. It is
822 safe to report lower value but a failure to report higher one. */
823
824 bc_l = 0;
825 bc_r = bp_location_count;
826 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
827 {
828 struct bp_location *b;
829
830 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
831 b = bp_location[bc];
832
833 /* Check first B->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added constant.
834 Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure the BC element can
835 in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR to MEMADDR + LEN range).
836
837 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety offset so that
838 we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow range tail still reaching
839 MEMADDR. */
840
841 if (b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max >= b->address
842 && b->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr)
843 bc_l = bc;
844 else
845 bc_r = bc;
846 }
847
848 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
849
850 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
851 {
852 struct bp_location *b = bp_location[bc];
853 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
854 int bp_size = 0;
855 int bptoffset = 0;
856
857 if (b->owner->type == bp_none)
858 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
859 b->owner->number);
860
861 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
862 content. */
863
864 if (b->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
865 && memaddr + len <= b->address
866 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
867 break;
868
869 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (b))
870 continue;
871 if (!breakpoint_address_match (b->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
872 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
873 continue;
874
875 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
876 we need to copy. */
877 bp_addr = b->target_info.placed_address;
878 bp_size = b->target_info.shadow_len;
879
880 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
881 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
882 are reading. */
883 continue;
884
885 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
886 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
887 reading. */
888 continue;
889
890 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
891 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
892 {
893 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
894 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
895 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
896 bp_addr = memaddr;
897 }
898
899 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
900 {
901 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
902 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
903 }
904
905 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
906 b->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
907 }
908 }
909 \f
910
911 /* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints. */
912 static void
913 insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
914 {
915 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
916 int val = -1;
917
918 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
919 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
920
921 b->ops->insert (b);
922 }
923
924 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
925
926 static int
927 is_hardware_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
928 {
929 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
930 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
931 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
932 }
933
934 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
935 software. */
936
937 static int
938 is_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
939 {
940 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
941 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
942 }
943
944 /* Find the current value of a watchpoint on EXP. Return the value in
945 *VALP and *RESULTP and the chain of intermediate and final values
946 in *VAL_CHAIN. RESULTP and VAL_CHAIN may be NULL if the caller does
947 not need them.
948
949 If a memory error occurs while evaluating the expression, *RESULTP will
950 be set to NULL. *RESULTP may be a lazy value, if the result could
951 not be read from memory. It is used to determine whether a value
952 is user-specified (we should watch the whole value) or intermediate
953 (we should watch only the bit used to locate the final value).
954
955 If the final value, or any intermediate value, could not be read
956 from memory, *VALP will be set to NULL. *VAL_CHAIN will still be
957 set to any referenced values. *VALP will never be a lazy value.
958 This is the value which we store in struct breakpoint.
959
960 If VAL_CHAIN is non-NULL, *VAL_CHAIN will be released from the
961 value chain. The caller must free the values individually. If
962 VAL_CHAIN is NULL, all generated values will be left on the value
963 chain. */
964
965 static void
966 fetch_watchpoint_value (struct expression *exp, struct value **valp,
967 struct value **resultp, struct value **val_chain)
968 {
969 struct value *mark, *new_mark, *result;
970 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
971
972 *valp = NULL;
973 if (resultp)
974 *resultp = NULL;
975 if (val_chain)
976 *val_chain = NULL;
977
978 /* Evaluate the expression. */
979 mark = value_mark ();
980 result = NULL;
981
982 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
983 {
984 result = evaluate_expression (exp);
985 }
986 if (ex.reason < 0)
987 {
988 /* Ignore memory errors, we want watchpoints pointing at
989 inaccessible memory to still be created; otherwise, throw the
990 error to some higher catcher. */
991 switch (ex.error)
992 {
993 case MEMORY_ERROR:
994 break;
995 default:
996 throw_exception (ex);
997 break;
998 }
999 }
1000
1001 new_mark = value_mark ();
1002 if (mark == new_mark)
1003 return;
1004 if (resultp)
1005 *resultp = result;
1006
1007 /* Make sure it's not lazy, so that after the target stops again we
1008 have a non-lazy previous value to compare with. */
1009 if (result != NULL
1010 && (!value_lazy (result) || gdb_value_fetch_lazy (result)))
1011 *valp = result;
1012
1013 if (val_chain)
1014 {
1015 /* Return the chain of intermediate values. We use this to
1016 decide which addresses to watch. */
1017 *val_chain = new_mark;
1018 value_release_to_mark (mark);
1019 }
1020 }
1021
1022 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
1023 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
1024 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
1025 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
1026 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
1027 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
1028 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
1029 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
1030 running. */
1031
1032 static int
1033 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1034 {
1035 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1036 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1037 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1038 }
1039
1040 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1041 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1042 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1043 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1044 in b->loc->cond.
1045 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1046
1047 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do nothing.
1048 If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete it.
1049
1050 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are removed
1051 + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must never be removed
1052 because they might be missed by a running thread when debugging in non-stop
1053 mode. On the other hand, hardware watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint;
1054 processed here) are specific to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's
1055 hardware debug registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in
1056 order to be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1057
1058 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being presented to the
1059 user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would reset the data used to
1060 present the watchpoint hit to the user. And it must not be done later
1061 because it could display the same single watchpoint hit during multiple GDB
1062 stops. Note that the latter is relevant only to the hardware watchpoint
1063 types bp_read_watchpoint and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by
1064 bp_hardware_watchpoint is not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the
1065 memory content has not changed.
1066
1067 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset hardware
1068 watchpoints:
1069
1070 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are called
1071 several times when GDB stops.
1072
1073 [linux]
1074 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, causing GDB to
1075 stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint hit at a time as the
1076 reason for stopping, and all the other hits are presented later, one after
1077 the other, each time the user requests the execution to be resumed.
1078 Execution is not resumed for the threads still having pending hit event
1079 stored in LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1080 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being reported
1081 from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address until the real
1082 thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets presented and thus its
1083 LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1084
1085 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the watchpoint
1086 removal from inferior. */
1087
1088 static void
1089 update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1090 {
1091 int within_current_scope;
1092 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1093 struct bp_location *loc;
1094 int frame_saved;
1095 bpstat bs;
1096
1097 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1098 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1099 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1100 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1101 return;
1102
1103 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in bp_location array and
1104 update_global_locations will eventually delete them and remove
1105 breakpoints if needed. */
1106 b->loc = NULL;
1107
1108 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1109 return;
1110
1111 frame_saved = 0;
1112
1113 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1114 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1115 within_current_scope = 1;
1116 else
1117 {
1118 struct frame_info *fi;
1119
1120 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1121 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1122 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1123 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1124 selected frame. */
1125 frame_saved = 1;
1126 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1127
1128 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1129 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1130 if (within_current_scope)
1131 select_frame (fi);
1132 }
1133
1134 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1135 {
1136 char *s;
1137 if (b->exp)
1138 {
1139 xfree (b->exp);
1140 b->exp = NULL;
1141 }
1142 s = b->exp_string;
1143 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1144 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1145 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1146 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1147 be completely different objects. */
1148 value_free (b->val);
1149 b->val = NULL;
1150 b->val_valid = 0;
1151
1152 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1153 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1154 locations (re)created below. */
1155 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1156 {
1157 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1158 {
1159 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1160 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1161 }
1162
1163 s = b->cond_string;
1164 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1165 }
1166 }
1167
1168 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1169 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1170 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1171 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1172 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1173 if ( !target_has_execution)
1174 {
1175 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1176 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1177 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1178 }
1179 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1180 {
1181 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1182 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1183
1184 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1185
1186 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1187 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1188 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1189 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1190 if (!b->val_valid)
1191 {
1192 b->val = v;
1193 b->val_valid = 1;
1194 }
1195
1196 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or an
1197 ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and free
1198 hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior is started. */
1199 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1200 && reparse)
1201 {
1202 int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1203
1204 /* We need to determine how many resources are already used
1205 for all other hardware watchpoints to see if we still have
1206 enough resources to also fit this watchpoint in as well.
1207 To avoid the hw_watchpoint_used_count call below from counting
1208 this watchpoint, make sure that it is marked as a software
1209 watchpoint. */
1210 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1211 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1212 &other_type_used);
1213 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1214
1215 if (!mem_cnt)
1216 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1217 else
1218 {
1219 int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1220 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1221 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1222 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1223 else
1224 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1225 }
1226 }
1227
1228 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1229
1230 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1231 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1232 {
1233 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1234 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1235 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1236 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1237 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1238 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1239 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1240 {
1241 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1242
1243 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1244 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1245 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1246 if (v == result
1247 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1248 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1249 {
1250 CORE_ADDR addr;
1251 int len, type;
1252 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1253
1254 addr = value_address (v);
1255 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1256 type = hw_write;
1257 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1258 type = hw_read;
1259 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1260 type = hw_access;
1261
1262 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1263 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1264 ;
1265 *tmp = loc;
1266 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1267
1268 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1269 loc->address = addr;
1270 loc->length = len;
1271 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1272 }
1273 }
1274
1275 next = value_next (v);
1276 if (v != b->val)
1277 value_free (v);
1278 }
1279
1280 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1281 above left it without any location set up. But,
1282 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1283 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1284 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1285 {
1286 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1287 b->loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1288 b->loc->address = -1;
1289 b->loc->length = -1;
1290 b->loc->watchpoint_type = -1;
1291 }
1292 }
1293 else if (!within_current_scope)
1294 {
1295 printf_filtered (_("\
1296 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block \n\
1297 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1298 b->number);
1299 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1300 {
1301 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1302 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
1303 b->related_breakpoint= NULL;
1304 }
1305 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1306 }
1307
1308 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1309 if (frame_saved)
1310 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1311 }
1312
1313
1314 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1315 inserted in the inferior. */
1316 static int
1317 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bpt)
1318 {
1319 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner))
1320 return 0;
1321
1322 if (bpt->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1323 return 0;
1324
1325 if (!bpt->enabled || bpt->shlib_disabled || bpt->duplicate)
1326 return 0;
1327
1328 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1329 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1330 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1331 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1332 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1333 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1334 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1335 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1336 if (bpt->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1337 return 0;
1338
1339 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1340 not by us. */
1341 if (tracepoint_type (bpt->owner))
1342 return 0;
1343
1344 return 1;
1345 }
1346
1347 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BPT is the breakpoint.
1348 Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and DISABLED_BREAKS,
1349 and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1350
1351 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an object-style
1352 method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1353 static int
1354 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bpt,
1355 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1356 int *disabled_breaks,
1357 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1358 {
1359 int val = 0;
1360
1361 if (!should_be_inserted (bpt) || bpt->inserted)
1362 return 0;
1363
1364 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1365 memset (&bpt->target_info, 0, sizeof (bpt->target_info));
1366 bpt->target_info.placed_address = bpt->address;
1367 bpt->target_info.placed_address_space = bpt->pspace->aspace;
1368
1369 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1370 || bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1371 {
1372 if (bpt->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1373 {
1374 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1375 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1376 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1377 Two important cases are:
1378 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1379 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1380 hardware breakpoint.
1381 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write.
1382 This means we've previously made the location hardware one, but
1383 then the memory map changed, so we undo.
1384
1385 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will
1386 use location types we've just set here, the only possible
1387 problem is that memory map has changed during running program,
1388 but it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
1389 struct mem_region *mr
1390 = lookup_mem_region (bpt->target_info.placed_address);
1391
1392 if (mr)
1393 {
1394 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1395 {
1396 int changed = 0;
1397 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1398
1399 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1400 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1401 else
1402 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1403
1404 if (new_type != bpt->loc_type)
1405 {
1406 static int said = 0;
1407 bpt->loc_type = new_type;
1408 if (!said)
1409 {
1410 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1411 Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1412 said = 1;
1413 }
1414 }
1415 }
1416 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1417 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1418 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1419 paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address));
1420 }
1421 }
1422
1423 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1424 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1425 || bpt->section == NULL
1426 || !(section_is_overlay (bpt->section)))
1427 {
1428 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1429
1430 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1431 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1432 &bpt->target_info);
1433 else
1434 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1435 &bpt->target_info);
1436 }
1437 else
1438 {
1439 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1440 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1441 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1442 {
1443 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1444 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1445 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1446 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1447 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1448 bpt->owner->number);
1449 else
1450 {
1451 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bpt->address,
1452 bpt->section);
1453 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1454 bpt->overlay_target_info = bpt->target_info;
1455 bpt->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1456 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1457 &bpt->overlay_target_info);
1458 if (val != 0)
1459 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1460 "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1461 bpt->owner->number);
1462 }
1463 }
1464 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1465 if (section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
1466 {
1467 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1468 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1469 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1470 &bpt->target_info);
1471 else
1472 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bpt->gdbarch,
1473 &bpt->target_info);
1474 }
1475 else
1476 {
1477 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1478 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1479 return 0;
1480 }
1481 }
1482
1483 if (val)
1484 {
1485 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1486 if (solib_name_from_address (bpt->pspace, bpt->address))
1487 {
1488 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1489 val = 0;
1490 bpt->shlib_disabled = 1;
1491 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1492 {
1493 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1494 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1495 bpt->owner->number);
1496 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1497 "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1498 }
1499 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1500 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1501 "breakpoint #%d\n", bpt->owner->number);
1502 }
1503 else
1504 {
1505 if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1506 {
1507 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1508 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1509 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1510 bpt->owner->number);
1511 }
1512 else
1513 {
1514 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1515 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1516 bpt->owner->number);
1517 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1518 "Error accessing memory address ");
1519 fputs_filtered (paddress (bpt->gdbarch, bpt->address),
1520 tmp_error_stream);
1521 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1522 safe_strerror (val));
1523 }
1524
1525 }
1526 }
1527 else
1528 bpt->inserted = 1;
1529
1530 return val;
1531 }
1532
1533 else if (bpt->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1534 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1535 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1536 && bpt->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1537 {
1538 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1539 bpt->length,
1540 bpt->watchpoint_type);
1541
1542 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
1543 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
1544 if (val == 1 && bpt->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
1545 {
1546 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1547
1548 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
1549 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
1550 of this one. */
1551 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1552 if (loc != bpt
1553 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
1554 && watchpoint_locations_match (bpt, loc))
1555 {
1556 bpt->duplicate = 1;
1557 bpt->inserted = 1;
1558 bpt->target_info = loc->target_info;
1559 bpt->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1560 val = 0;
1561 break;
1562 }
1563
1564 if (val == 1)
1565 {
1566 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bpt->address,
1567 bpt->length,
1568 hw_access);
1569 if (val == 0)
1570 bpt->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1571 }
1572 }
1573
1574 bpt->inserted = (val == 0);
1575 }
1576
1577 else if (bpt->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1578 {
1579 struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1580 bpt->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1581 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1582 bpt->owner->number);
1583 if (e.reason < 0)
1584 bpt->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1585 else
1586 bpt->inserted = 1;
1587
1588 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1589 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1590 so just return success. */
1591 return 0;
1592 }
1593
1594 return 0;
1595 }
1596
1597 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1598 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1599 PSPACE anymore. */
1600
1601 void
1602 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1603 {
1604 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1605 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1606
1607 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1608 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1609 {
1610 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1611 delete_breakpoint (b);
1612 }
1613
1614 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1615 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1616 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1617 {
1618 struct bp_location *tmp;
1619
1620 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1621 {
1622 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1623 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1624 else
1625 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1626 if (tmp->next == loc)
1627 {
1628 tmp->next = loc->next;
1629 break;
1630 }
1631 }
1632 }
1633
1634 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1635 removed locations above. */
1636 update_global_location_list (0);
1637 }
1638
1639 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1640 Throws exception on any error.
1641 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1642 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1643 void
1644 insert_breakpoints (void)
1645 {
1646 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1647
1648 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1649 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1650 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1651
1652 update_global_location_list (1);
1653
1654 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1655 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1656 now. */
1657 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1658 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1659 }
1660
1661 /* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1662 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1663 Both return zero if successful,
1664 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1665
1666 static void
1667 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1668 {
1669 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1670 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1671 int error = 0;
1672 int val = 0;
1673 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1674 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1675
1676 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1677 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1678
1679 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1680 there was an error. */
1681 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1682
1683 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1684
1685 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1686 {
1687 struct thread_info *tp;
1688 CORE_ADDR last_addr;
1689
1690 if (!should_be_inserted (b) || b->inserted)
1691 continue;
1692
1693 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if the
1694 thread no longer exists. */
1695 if (b->owner->thread != -1
1696 && !valid_thread_id (b->owner->thread))
1697 continue;
1698
1699 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
1700
1701 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1702 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1703 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1704 insert breakpoints. */
1705 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1706 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1707 continue;
1708
1709 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1710 &disabled_breaks,
1711 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1712 if (val)
1713 error = val;
1714 }
1715
1716 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint,
1717 remove them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1718 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1719 {
1720 int some_failed = 0;
1721 struct bp_location *loc;
1722
1723 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1724 continue;
1725
1726 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1727 continue;
1728
1729 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1730 continue;
1731
1732 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1733 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1734 {
1735 some_failed = 1;
1736 break;
1737 }
1738 if (some_failed)
1739 {
1740 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1741 if (loc->inserted)
1742 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1743
1744 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1745 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1746 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1747 bpt->number);
1748 error = -1;
1749 }
1750 }
1751
1752 if (error)
1753 {
1754 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1755 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1756 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1757 {
1758 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1759 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
1760 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
1761 }
1762 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
1763 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
1764 }
1765
1766 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1767 }
1768
1769 int
1770 remove_breakpoints (void)
1771 {
1772 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1773 int val = 0;
1774
1775 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1776 {
1777 if (b->inserted)
1778 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1779 }
1780 return val;
1781 }
1782
1783 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
1784
1785 int
1786 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
1787 {
1788 struct bp_location *b, **b_tmp;
1789 int val;
1790 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1791
1792 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, b_tmp)
1793 {
1794 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1795 continue;
1796
1797 if (b->inserted)
1798 {
1799 val = remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1800 if (val != 0)
1801 return val;
1802 }
1803 }
1804 return 0;
1805 }
1806
1807 int
1808 remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
1809 {
1810 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1811 int val = 0;
1812
1813 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1814 {
1815 if (b->inserted && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
1816 val |= remove_breakpoint (b, mark_uninserted);
1817 }
1818 return val;
1819 }
1820
1821 int
1822 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
1823 {
1824 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1825 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
1826 int val;
1827 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1828 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
1829 struct inferior *inf;
1830 struct thread_info *tp;
1831
1832 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
1833 if (tp == NULL)
1834 return 1;
1835
1836 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
1837 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
1838
1839 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
1840
1841 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1842
1843 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
1844 {
1845 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
1846 continue;
1847
1848 if (b->inserted)
1849 {
1850 b->inserted = 0;
1851 val = insert_bp_location (b, tmp_error_stream,
1852 &dummy1, &dummy2);
1853 if (val != 0)
1854 {
1855 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1856 return val;
1857 }
1858 }
1859 }
1860 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1861 return 0;
1862 }
1863
1864 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
1865
1866 static struct breakpoint *
1867 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
1868 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
1869 {
1870 struct symtab_and_line sal;
1871 struct breakpoint *b;
1872
1873 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
1874
1875 sal.pc = address;
1876 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
1877 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
1878
1879 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
1880 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
1881 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
1882
1883 return b;
1884 }
1885
1886 static void
1887 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1888 {
1889 struct objfile *objfile;
1890
1891 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1892 {
1893 struct breakpoint *b;
1894 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1895
1896 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1897 if (m == NULL)
1898 continue;
1899
1900 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1901 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1902 bp_overlay_event);
1903 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1904
1905 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
1906 {
1907 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
1908 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
1909 }
1910 else
1911 {
1912 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1913 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
1914 }
1915 }
1916 update_global_location_list (1);
1917 }
1918
1919 static void
1920 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
1921 {
1922 struct program_space *pspace;
1923 struct objfile *objfile;
1924 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1925
1926 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
1927
1928 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
1929 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
1930 {
1931 struct breakpoint *b;
1932 struct minimal_symbol *m;
1933
1934 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
1935 continue;
1936
1937 set_current_program_space (pspace);
1938
1939 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
1940 if (m == NULL)
1941 continue;
1942
1943 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
1944 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
1945 bp_longjmp_master);
1946 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
1947 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1948 }
1949 update_global_location_list (1);
1950
1951 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1952 }
1953
1954 void
1955 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
1956 {
1957 struct breakpoint *b;
1958 struct breakpoint *temp;
1959 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
1960
1961 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
1962 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
1963 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
1964 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
1965 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
1966 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
1967 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
1968 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
1969 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
1970 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
1971 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
1972
1973 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
1974 {
1975 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
1976 continue;
1977
1978 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1979 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
1980 {
1981 delete_breakpoint (b);
1982 continue;
1983 }
1984
1985 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
1986 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
1987 {
1988 delete_breakpoint (b);
1989 continue;
1990 }
1991
1992 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
1993 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
1994 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
1995 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
1996 {
1997 delete_breakpoint (b);
1998 continue;
1999 }
2000
2001 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
2002 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
2003 {
2004 delete_breakpoint (b);
2005 continue;
2006 }
2007
2008 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
2009 after an exec. */
2010 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume)
2011 {
2012 delete_breakpoint (b);
2013 continue;
2014 }
2015
2016 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
2017 {
2018 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
2019 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
2020 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
2021 a new method, and call this method from here. */
2022 continue;
2023 }
2024
2025 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
2026 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
2027 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
2028 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
2029 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
2030 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
2031
2032 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
2033 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
2034 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
2035 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
2036 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
2037 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
2038 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
2039
2040 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
2041 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
2042 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
2043 let finish_command delete it.
2044
2045 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
2046 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
2047 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
2048 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
2049 solib breakpoints.) */
2050
2051 if (b->type == bp_finish)
2052 {
2053 continue;
2054 }
2055
2056 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
2057 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
2058 a.out. */
2059 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
2060 {
2061 delete_breakpoint (b);
2062 continue;
2063 }
2064 }
2065 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
2066 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
2067 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
2068 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
2069 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
2070 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
2071 }
2072
2073 int
2074 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
2075 {
2076 struct bp_location *b, **bp_tmp;
2077 int val = 0;
2078 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
2079 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
2080
2081 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
2082 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
2083
2084 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
2085 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
2086 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (b, bp_tmp)
2087 {
2088 if (b->pspace != inf->pspace)
2089 continue;
2090
2091 if (b->inserted)
2092 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (b, mark_inserted);
2093 }
2094 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2095 return val;
2096 }
2097
2098 /* Remove the breakpoint location B from the current address space.
2099 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2100 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2101 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2102 *not* look at b->pspace->aspace here. */
2103
2104 static int
2105 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2106 {
2107 int val;
2108 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2109
2110 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2111 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2112 return 0;
2113
2114 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2115 This should not ever happen. */
2116 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2117
2118 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2119 || b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2120 {
2121 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2122 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2123 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2124
2125 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2126 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2127 || b->section == NULL
2128 || !(section_is_overlay (b->section)))
2129 {
2130 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2131
2132 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2133 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2134 else
2135 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch, &b->target_info);
2136 }
2137 else
2138 {
2139 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2140 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2141 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2142 {
2143 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2144 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2145 */
2146 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2147 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2148 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2149 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2150 &b->overlay_target_info);
2151 else
2152 target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2153 &b->overlay_target_info);
2154 }
2155 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2156 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2157 if (b->inserted)
2158 {
2159 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2160 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2161 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2162 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2163 if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2164 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2165 &b->target_info);
2166
2167 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2168 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2169 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2170 else if (section_is_mapped (b->section))
2171 val = target_remove_breakpoint (b->gdbarch,
2172 &b->target_info);
2173 else
2174 val = 0;
2175 }
2176 else
2177 {
2178 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2179 val = 0;
2180 }
2181 }
2182
2183 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2184 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2185 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2186 if (val && solib_name_from_address (b->pspace, b->address))
2187 val = 0;
2188
2189 if (val)
2190 return val;
2191 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2192 }
2193 else if (b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2194 {
2195 struct value *v;
2196 struct value *n;
2197
2198 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2199 val = target_remove_watchpoint (b->address, b->length,
2200 b->watchpoint_type);
2201
2202 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2203 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (b->inserted))
2204 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2205 b->owner->number);
2206 }
2207 else if (b->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2208 && breakpoint_enabled (b->owner)
2209 && !b->duplicate)
2210 {
2211 gdb_assert (b->owner->ops != NULL && b->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2212
2213 val = b->owner->ops->remove (b->owner);
2214 if (val)
2215 return val;
2216 b->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2217 }
2218
2219 return 0;
2220 }
2221
2222 static int
2223 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *b, insertion_state_t is)
2224 {
2225 int ret;
2226 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2227
2228 if (b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2229 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2230 return 0;
2231
2232 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2233 This should not ever happen. */
2234 gdb_assert (b->owner->type != bp_none);
2235
2236 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2237
2238 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
2239
2240 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (b, is);
2241
2242 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2243 return ret;
2244 }
2245
2246 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2247
2248 void
2249 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2250 {
2251 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2252
2253 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2254 if (bpt->pspace == current_program_space)
2255 bpt->inserted = 0;
2256 }
2257
2258 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2259 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2260
2261 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2262 between runs.
2263
2264 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2265 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2266 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2267
2268
2269
2270 void
2271 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2272 {
2273 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
2274 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2275 int ix;
2276 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2277
2278 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2279 nothing to do. */
2280 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2281 return;
2282
2283 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2284 {
2285 if (bpt->pspace == pspace
2286 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2287 bpt->inserted = 0;
2288 }
2289
2290 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
2291 {
2292 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2293 continue;
2294
2295 switch (b->type)
2296 {
2297 case bp_call_dummy:
2298
2299 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2300 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
2301 rid of it. */
2302
2303 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2304
2305 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2306
2307 case bp_shlib_event:
2308
2309 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
2310 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
2311 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
2312 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
2313 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
2314
2315 (gdb) file prog-linux
2316 (gdb) run # native linux target
2317 ...
2318 (gdb) kill
2319 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
2320 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
2321 */
2322
2323 delete_breakpoint (b);
2324 break;
2325
2326 case bp_watchpoint:
2327 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2328 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2329 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2330
2331 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2332 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2333 delete_breakpoint (b);
2334 else if (context == inf_starting)
2335 {
2336 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value
2337 in insert_breakpoints. */
2338 if (b->val)
2339 value_free (b->val);
2340 b->val = NULL;
2341 b->val_valid = 0;
2342 }
2343 break;
2344 default:
2345 break;
2346 }
2347 }
2348
2349 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2350 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bpt); ++ix)
2351 free_bp_location (bpt);
2352 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2353 }
2354
2355 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2356 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2357 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2358 match, not program space. */
2359
2360 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2361 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2362 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2363 permanent breakpoint.
2364 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2365 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2366 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2367 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2368 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2369
2370 enum breakpoint_here
2371 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2372 {
2373 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2374 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2375
2376 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2377 {
2378 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2379 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2380 continue;
2381
2382 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2383 || bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2384 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2385 aspace, pc))
2386 {
2387 if (overlay_debugging
2388 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2389 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2390 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2391 else if (bpt->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2392 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2393 else
2394 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2395 }
2396 }
2397
2398 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2399 }
2400
2401 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2402
2403 int
2404 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2405 {
2406 struct bp_location *loc;
2407 int ix;
2408
2409 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2410 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2411 aspace, pc))
2412 return 1;
2413
2414 return 0;
2415 }
2416
2417 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2418 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array mechanism.
2419 This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which are
2420 inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2421
2422 int
2423 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2424 {
2425 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2426
2427 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2428 {
2429 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2430 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2431 continue;
2432
2433 if (bpt->inserted
2434 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2435 aspace, pc))
2436 {
2437 if (overlay_debugging
2438 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2439 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2440 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2441 else
2442 return 1;
2443 }
2444 }
2445 return 0;
2446 }
2447
2448 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2449 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2450
2451 int
2452 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2453 {
2454 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2455 return 1;
2456
2457 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2458 return 1;
2459
2460 return 0;
2461 }
2462
2463 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2464 inserted at PC. */
2465
2466 int
2467 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2468 {
2469 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2470 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2471
2472 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2473 {
2474 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2475 continue;
2476
2477 if (bpt->inserted
2478 && breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2479 aspace, pc))
2480 {
2481 if (overlay_debugging
2482 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2483 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2484 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2485 else
2486 return 1;
2487 }
2488 }
2489
2490 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2491 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2492 return 1;
2493
2494 return 0;
2495 }
2496
2497 int
2498 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2499 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2500 {
2501 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2502
2503 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2504 {
2505 struct bp_location *loc;
2506
2507 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2508 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2509 continue;
2510
2511 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2512 continue;
2513
2514 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2515 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2516 {
2517 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2518
2519 /* Check for intersection. */
2520 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2521 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2522 if (l < h)
2523 return 1;
2524 }
2525 }
2526 return 0;
2527 }
2528
2529 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2530 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2531
2532 int
2533 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2534 ptid_t ptid)
2535 {
2536 struct bp_location *bpt, **bptp_tmp;
2537 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2538 int thread = -1;
2539 int task = 0;
2540
2541 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bpt, bptp_tmp)
2542 {
2543 if (bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2544 && bpt->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2545 continue;
2546
2547 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt->owner)
2548 && bpt->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2549 continue;
2550
2551 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bpt->pspace->aspace, bpt->address,
2552 aspace, pc))
2553 continue;
2554
2555 if (bpt->owner->thread != -1)
2556 {
2557 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2558 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2559 it is now time to do so. */
2560 if (thread == -1)
2561 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2562 if (bpt->owner->thread != thread)
2563 continue;
2564 }
2565
2566 if (bpt->owner->task != 0)
2567 {
2568 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2569 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2570 it is now time to do so. */
2571 if (task == 0)
2572 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2573 if (bpt->owner->task != task)
2574 continue;
2575 }
2576
2577 if (overlay_debugging
2578 && section_is_overlay (bpt->section)
2579 && !section_is_mapped (bpt->section))
2580 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2581
2582 return 1;
2583 }
2584
2585 return 0;
2586 }
2587 \f
2588
2589 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2590 in breakpoint.h. */
2591
2592 int
2593 ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2594 {
2595 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2596 }
2597
2598 void
2599 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2600 {
2601 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2602 value_free (bs->old_val);
2603 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2604 xfree (bs);
2605 }
2606
2607 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2608 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
2609
2610 void
2611 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2612 {
2613 bpstat p;
2614 bpstat q;
2615
2616 if (bsp == 0)
2617 return;
2618 p = *bsp;
2619 while (p != NULL)
2620 {
2621 q = p->next;
2622 bpstat_free (p);
2623 p = q;
2624 }
2625 *bsp = NULL;
2626 }
2627
2628 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2629 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
2630
2631 bpstat
2632 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2633 {
2634 bpstat p = NULL;
2635 bpstat tmp;
2636 bpstat retval = NULL;
2637
2638 if (bs == NULL)
2639 return bs;
2640
2641 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2642 {
2643 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2644 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2645 if (bs->commands != NULL)
2646 tmp->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
2647 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2648 {
2649 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2650 release_value (tmp->old_val);
2651 }
2652
2653 if (p == NULL)
2654 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
2655 retval = tmp;
2656 else
2657 p->next = tmp;
2658 p = tmp;
2659 }
2660 p->next = NULL;
2661 return retval;
2662 }
2663
2664 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint */
2665
2666 bpstat
2667 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
2668 {
2669 if (bsp == NULL)
2670 return NULL;
2671
2672 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2673 {
2674 if (bsp->breakpoint_at && bsp->breakpoint_at->owner == breakpoint)
2675 return bsp;
2676 }
2677 return NULL;
2678 }
2679
2680 /* Find a step_resume breakpoint associated with this bpstat.
2681 (If there are multiple step_resume bp's on the list, this function
2682 will arbitrarily pick one.)
2683
2684 It is an error to use this function if BPSTAT doesn't contain a
2685 step_resume breakpoint.
2686
2687 See wait_for_inferior's use of this function. */
2688 struct breakpoint *
2689 bpstat_find_step_resume_breakpoint (bpstat bsp)
2690 {
2691 int current_thread;
2692
2693 gdb_assert (bsp != NULL);
2694
2695 current_thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
2696
2697 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
2698 {
2699 if ((bsp->breakpoint_at != NULL)
2700 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->type == bp_step_resume)
2701 && (bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == current_thread
2702 || bsp->breakpoint_at->owner->thread == -1))
2703 return bsp->breakpoint_at->owner;
2704 }
2705
2706 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("No step_resume breakpoint found."));
2707 }
2708
2709
2710 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are stopped
2711 at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the remaining
2712 breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be good for
2713 anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
2714 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
2715 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
2716 we set it.
2717 Return 1 otherwise. */
2718
2719 int
2720 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
2721 {
2722 struct breakpoint *b;
2723
2724 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
2725 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
2726
2727 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that
2728 correspond to a single breakpoint -- otherwise,
2729 this function might return the same number more
2730 than once and this will look ugly. */
2731 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at ? (*bsp)->breakpoint_at->owner : NULL;
2732 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
2733 if (b == NULL)
2734 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
2735
2736 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
2737 return 1;
2738 }
2739
2740 /* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
2741
2742 void
2743 bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
2744 {
2745 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2746 {
2747 free_command_lines (&bs->commands);
2748 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2749 {
2750 value_free (bs->old_val);
2751 bs->old_val = NULL;
2752 }
2753 }
2754 }
2755
2756 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
2757
2758 static void
2759 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
2760 {
2761 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
2762 {
2763 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
2764
2765 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
2766 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
2767 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
2768 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
2769 if (tp->in_infcall)
2770 return;
2771 }
2772
2773 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
2774 }
2775
2776 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint command */
2777 static void
2778 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
2779 {
2780 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
2781 }
2782
2783 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at this
2784 location. Any of these commands could cause the process to proceed
2785 beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by checking
2786 the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
2787
2788 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
2789 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
2790 bpstat of the current thread. */
2791
2792 static int
2793 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
2794 {
2795 bpstat bs;
2796 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2797 int again = 0;
2798
2799 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
2800 in bs->commands. */
2801 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
2802 return 0;
2803
2804 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
2805 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
2806
2807 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
2808 bs = *bsp;
2809
2810 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
2811 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2812 {
2813 struct command_line *cmd;
2814 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
2815
2816 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
2817
2818 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
2819 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
2820 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
2821 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
2822 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
2823 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
2824 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
2825 the tree when we're done. */
2826 cmd = bs->commands;
2827 bs->commands = 0;
2828 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_free_command_lines (&cmd);
2829
2830 while (cmd != NULL)
2831 {
2832 execute_control_command (cmd);
2833
2834 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2835 break;
2836 else
2837 cmd = cmd->next;
2838 }
2839
2840 /* We can free this command tree now. */
2841 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
2842
2843 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
2844 {
2845 if (target_can_async_p ())
2846 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
2847 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
2848 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
2849 ;
2850 else
2851 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
2852 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
2853 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
2854 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
2855 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
2856 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
2857 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
2858 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
2859 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
2860 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
2861 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
2862 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
2863 with the new stop_bpstat. */
2864 again = 1;
2865 break;
2866 }
2867 }
2868 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2869 return again;
2870 }
2871
2872 void
2873 bpstat_do_actions (void)
2874 {
2875 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
2876 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
2877 && target_has_execution
2878 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
2879 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
2880 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
2881 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
2882 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
2883 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
2884 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->stop_bpstat))
2885 break;
2886 }
2887
2888 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
2889
2890 static void
2891 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
2892 {
2893 if (val == NULL)
2894 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
2895 else
2896 {
2897 struct value_print_options opts;
2898 get_user_print_options (&opts);
2899 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
2900 }
2901 }
2902
2903 /* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
2904 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
2905 by having it set different print_it values.
2906
2907 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
2908 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
2909 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
2910 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
2911 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
2912
2913 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
2914 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
2915 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
2916 don't print anything else.
2917 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
2918 that something to be followed by a location.
2919 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
2920 that something to be followed by a location.
2921 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
2922 analysis. */
2923
2924 static enum print_stop_action
2925 print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
2926 {
2927 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2928 struct breakpoint *b;
2929 const struct bp_location *bl;
2930 struct ui_stream *stb;
2931 int bp_temp = 0;
2932 enum print_stop_action result;
2933
2934 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
2935 which has since been deleted. */
2936 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
2937 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
2938 bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
2939 b = bl->owner;
2940
2941 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
2942 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
2943
2944 switch (b->type)
2945 {
2946 case bp_breakpoint:
2947 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
2948 bp_temp = bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del;
2949 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
2950 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
2951 bl->address,
2952 b->number, 1);
2953 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
2954 if (bp_temp)
2955 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
2956 else
2957 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
2958 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
2959 {
2960 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
2961 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
2962 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
2963 }
2964 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
2965 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
2966 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
2967 break;
2968
2969 case bp_shlib_event:
2970 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
2971 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
2972 to shlib event" message.) */
2973 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
2974 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2975 break;
2976
2977 case bp_thread_event:
2978 /* Not sure how we will get here.
2979 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
2980 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2981 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2982 break;
2983
2984 case bp_overlay_event:
2985 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
2986 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2987 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2988 break;
2989
2990 case bp_longjmp_master:
2991 /* These should never be enabled. */
2992 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
2993 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
2994 break;
2995
2996 case bp_watchpoint:
2997 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2998 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
2999 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3000 ui_out_field_string
3001 (uiout, "reason",
3002 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3003 mention (b);
3004 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3005 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3006 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3007 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3008 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3009 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3010 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3011 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3012 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
3013 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3014 break;
3015
3016 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3017 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3018 ui_out_field_string
3019 (uiout, "reason",
3020 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3021 mention (b);
3022 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3023 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3024 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3025 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
3026 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3027 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3028 break;
3029
3030 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3031 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3032 {
3033 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
3034 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3035 ui_out_field_string
3036 (uiout, "reason",
3037 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3038 mention (b);
3039 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3040 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3041 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3042 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3043 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3044 }
3045 else
3046 {
3047 mention (b);
3048 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3049 ui_out_field_string
3050 (uiout, "reason",
3051 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3052 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3053 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3054 }
3055 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3056 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3057 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3058 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3059 break;
3060
3061 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
3062 here. */
3063
3064 case bp_finish:
3065 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3066 ui_out_field_string
3067 (uiout, "reason",
3068 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
3069 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3070 break;
3071
3072 case bp_until:
3073 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3074 ui_out_field_string
3075 (uiout, "reason",
3076 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
3077 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3078 break;
3079
3080 case bp_none:
3081 case bp_longjmp:
3082 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3083 case bp_step_resume:
3084 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3085 case bp_call_dummy:
3086 case bp_tracepoint:
3087 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
3088 case bp_jit_event:
3089 default:
3090 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3091 break;
3092 }
3093
3094 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3095 return result;
3096 }
3097
3098 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
3099 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
3100 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
3101 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
3102 normal_stop(). */
3103
3104 static enum print_stop_action
3105 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
3106 {
3107 switch (bs->print_it)
3108 {
3109 case print_it_noop:
3110 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
3111 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3112 break;
3113
3114 case print_it_done:
3115 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3116 relevant messages. */
3117 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3118 break;
3119
3120 case print_it_normal:
3121 {
3122 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3123 struct breakpoint *b = bl ? bl->owner : NULL;
3124
3125 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3126 print_it_typical. */
3127 /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here? */
3128 if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3129 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3130 else
3131 return print_it_typical (bs);
3132 }
3133 break;
3134
3135 default:
3136 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3137 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3138 break;
3139 }
3140 }
3141
3142 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3143 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3144 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3145 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3146 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3147 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3148 routine is one of:
3149
3150 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing
3151 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3152 code to print the location. An example is
3153 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3154 the location.
3155 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3156 to also print the location part of the message.
3157 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3158 don't require a location appended to the end.
3159 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3160 further info to be printed.*/
3161
3162 enum print_stop_action
3163 bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3164 {
3165 int val;
3166
3167 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3168 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3169 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3170 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3171 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3172 {
3173 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3174 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3175 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3176 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3177 return val;
3178 }
3179
3180 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3181 with and nothing was printed. */
3182 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3183 }
3184
3185 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
3186 This is used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3187 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to char * to
3188 make it pass through catch_errors. */
3189
3190 static int
3191 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3192 {
3193 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3194 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3195 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3196 return i;
3197 }
3198
3199 /* Allocate a new bpstat and chain it to the current one. */
3200
3201 static bpstat
3202 bpstat_alloc (const struct bp_location *bl, bpstat cbs /* Current "bs" value */ )
3203 {
3204 bpstat bs;
3205
3206 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3207 cbs->next = bs;
3208 bs->breakpoint_at = bl;
3209 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3210 bs->commands = NULL;
3211 bs->old_val = NULL;
3212 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3213 return bs;
3214 }
3215 \f
3216 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3217 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3218
3219 int
3220 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3221 {
3222 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3223 CORE_ADDR addr;
3224 struct breakpoint *b;
3225
3226 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3227 {
3228 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3229 as not triggered. */
3230 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3231 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3232 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3233 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3234 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3235
3236 return 0;
3237 }
3238
3239 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3240 {
3241 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3242 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3243 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3244 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3245 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3246 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3247 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3248
3249 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3250 }
3251
3252 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3253 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3254 triggered. */
3255
3256 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3257 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3258 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3259 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3260 {
3261 struct bp_location *loc;
3262 struct value *v;
3263
3264 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3265 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3266 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3267 sufficient. */
3268 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3269 addr, loc->address,
3270 loc->length))
3271 {
3272 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3273 break;
3274 }
3275 }
3276
3277 return 1;
3278 }
3279
3280 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3281 because of check_errors). */
3282 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3283 #define WP_DELETED 1
3284 /* The value has changed. */
3285 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3286 /* The value has not changed. */
3287 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3288 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
3289 #define WP_IGNORE 4
3290
3291 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3292 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3293
3294 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value changed.
3295
3296 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
3297 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
3298
3299 static int
3300 watchpoint_check (void *p)
3301 {
3302 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3303 struct breakpoint *b;
3304 struct frame_info *fr;
3305 int within_current_scope;
3306
3307 b = bs->breakpoint_at->owner;
3308
3309 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3310 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3311 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3312 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3313 return WP_IGNORE;
3314
3315 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3316 within_current_scope = 1;
3317 else
3318 {
3319 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3320 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3321 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3322
3323 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're still
3324 in the function but the stack frame has already been invalidated.
3325 Since we can't rely on the values of local variables after the
3326 stack has been destroyed, we are treating the watchpoint in that
3327 state as `not changed' without further checking. Don't mark
3328 watchpoints as changed if the current frame is in an epilogue -
3329 even if they are in some other frame, our view of the stack
3330 is likely to be wrong and frame_find_by_id could error out. */
3331 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3332 return WP_IGNORE;
3333
3334 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3335 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3336
3337 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3338 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3339 if (within_current_scope)
3340 {
3341 struct symbol *function;
3342
3343 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3344 if (function == NULL
3345 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3346 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3347 within_current_scope = 0;
3348 }
3349
3350 if (within_current_scope)
3351 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3352 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3353 the user. */
3354 select_frame (fr);
3355 }
3356
3357 if (within_current_scope)
3358 {
3359 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a
3360 *long* time before we return to the command level and
3361 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because
3362 we might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3363
3364 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3365 struct value *new_val;
3366
3367 fetch_watchpoint_value (b->exp, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3368
3369 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because the latter
3370 coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just the address of the
3371 array instead of its contents. This is not what we want. */
3372 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3373 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
3374 {
3375 if (new_val != NULL)
3376 {
3377 release_value (new_val);
3378 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3379 }
3380 bs->old_val = b->val;
3381 b->val = new_val;
3382 b->val_valid = 1;
3383 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3384 }
3385 else
3386 {
3387 /* Nothing changed. */
3388 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3389 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3390 }
3391 }
3392 else
3393 {
3394 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3395 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3396 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3397 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3398 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3399 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3400 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3401 the first value assigned). */
3402 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3403 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3404 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3405 information here. */
3406 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3407 ui_out_field_string
3408 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3409 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3410 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3411 ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3412 which its expression is valid.\n");
3413
3414 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3415 {
3416 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3417 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3418 b->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3419 }
3420 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3421
3422 return WP_DELETED;
3423 }
3424 }
3425
3426 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3427 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3428 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3429 static int
3430 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3431 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3432 {
3433 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3434
3435 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3436 tracepoints. */
3437 if (tracepoint_type (b))
3438 return 0;
3439
3440 if (b->type != bp_watchpoint
3441 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
3442 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
3443 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint
3444 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3445 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3446 {
3447 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3448 aspace, bp_addr))
3449 return 0;
3450 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3451 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3452 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3453 return 0;
3454 }
3455
3456 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3457 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3458 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3459 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3460 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3461 (did not match the data address). */
3462
3463 if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3464 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3465 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3466 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3467 return 0;
3468
3469 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3470 {
3471 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3472 return 0;
3473 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3474 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3475 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3476 return 0;
3477 }
3478
3479 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3480 {
3481 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3482 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3483 return 0;
3484 }
3485
3486 return 1;
3487 }
3488
3489 /* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3490 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3491 to 0. */
3492 static void
3493 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3494 {
3495 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3496 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3497
3498 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint
3499 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
3500 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
3501 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3502 {
3503 CORE_ADDR addr;
3504 struct value *v;
3505 int must_check_value = 0;
3506
3507 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3508 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3509 watched value. */
3510 must_check_value = 1;
3511 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3512 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3513 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3514 this watchpoint. */
3515 must_check_value = 1;
3516 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3517 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3518 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3519 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3520 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3521 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3522 must_check_value = 1;
3523
3524 if (must_check_value)
3525 {
3526 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3527 b->number);
3528 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3529 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3530 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3531 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3532 switch (e)
3533 {
3534 case WP_DELETED:
3535 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3536 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3537 /* Stop. */
3538 break;
3539 case WP_IGNORE:
3540 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3541 bs->stop = 0;
3542 break;
3543 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3544 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3545 {
3546 /* There are two cases to consider here:
3547
3548 1. we're watching the triggered memory for reads.
3549 In that case, trust the target, and always report
3550 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
3551 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
3552 have changed since the last time it was read, and
3553 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
3554 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
3555 old value.
3556
3557 2. we're watching the triggered memory for both
3558 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
3559 happen:
3560
3561 2.1. this is a target that can't break on data
3562 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
3563 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
3564 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
3565
3566 2.2. otherwise, the target supports read
3567 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
3568 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
3569 watchpoint.
3570
3571 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
3572 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
3573 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
3574 changes. This still gives false positives when
3575 the program writes the same value to memory as
3576 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
3577 it for a read), but it's much better than
3578 nothing. */
3579
3580 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
3581
3582 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
3583 {
3584 struct breakpoint *other_b;
3585
3586 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
3587 if ((other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3588 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3589 && (other_b->watchpoint_triggered
3590 == watch_triggered_yes))
3591 {
3592 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
3593 break;
3594 }
3595 }
3596
3597 if (other_write_watchpoint
3598 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
3599 {
3600 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
3601 and the value changed since the last time we
3602 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
3603 Ignore it. */
3604 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3605 bs->stop = 0;
3606 }
3607 }
3608 break;
3609 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3610 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3611 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3612 {
3613 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3614 the value hasn't changed. */
3615 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3616 bs->stop = 0;
3617 }
3618 /* Stop. */
3619 break;
3620 default:
3621 /* Can't happen. */
3622 case 0:
3623 /* Error from catch_errors. */
3624 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3625 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3626 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3627 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3628 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3629 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3630 break;
3631 }
3632 }
3633 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
3634 {
3635 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3636 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3637 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
3638 anything for this watchpoint. */
3639 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3640 bs->stop = 0;
3641 }
3642 }
3643 }
3644
3645
3646 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3647 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
3648 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
3649 static void
3650 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3651 {
3652 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3653 const struct bp_location *bl = bs->breakpoint_at;
3654 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3655
3656 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
3657 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
3658 bs->stop = 0;
3659 else if (bs->stop)
3660 {
3661 int value_is_zero = 0;
3662 struct expression *cond;
3663
3664 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
3665 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
3666 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
3667 iteration. */
3668 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
3669 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3670
3671 if (is_watchpoint (b))
3672 cond = b->cond_exp;
3673 else
3674 cond = bl->cond;
3675
3676 if (cond && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
3677 {
3678 int within_current_scope = 1;
3679
3680 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
3681 be a long time before we return to the command level and
3682 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
3683 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
3684 function call. */
3685 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3686
3687 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
3688 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
3689 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
3690 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
3691 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
3692 call site. */
3693 if (!is_watchpoint (b) || b->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
3694 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
3695 else
3696 {
3697 struct frame_info *frame;
3698
3699 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
3700 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
3701 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
3702 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
3703 really matter which instantiation of the function
3704 where the condition makes sense triggers the
3705 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
3706 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
3707 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
3708 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
3709 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
3710 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
3711 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
3712 intuitive. */
3713 frame = block_innermost_frame (b->cond_exp_valid_block);
3714 if (frame != NULL)
3715 select_frame (frame);
3716 else
3717 within_current_scope = 0;
3718 }
3719 if (within_current_scope)
3720 value_is_zero
3721 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
3722 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
3723 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3724 else
3725 {
3726 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
3727 "in the current scope"));
3728 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
3729 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
3730 value_is_zero = 0;
3731 }
3732 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint # */
3733 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3734 }
3735
3736 if (cond && value_is_zero)
3737 {
3738 bs->stop = 0;
3739 }
3740 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
3741 {
3742 bs->stop = 0;
3743 }
3744 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
3745 {
3746 b->ignore_count--;
3747 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
3748 bs->stop = 0;
3749 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't
3750 stop. */
3751 ++(b->hit_count);
3752 }
3753 }
3754 }
3755
3756
3757 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
3758 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
3759
3760 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
3761 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such that:
3762
3763 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
3764
3765 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
3766
3767 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
3768 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
3769 several reasons concurrently.)
3770
3771 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
3772 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
3773
3774 bpstat
3775 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
3776 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
3777 {
3778 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
3779 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3780 struct bp_location *loc;
3781 /* Root of the chain of bpstat's */
3782 struct bpstats root_bs[1];
3783 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
3784 bpstat bs = root_bs;
3785 int ix;
3786 int need_remove_insert;
3787
3788 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS iteration would break across
3789 update_global_location_list possibly executed by
3790 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions's inferior call. */
3791
3792 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3793 {
3794 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3795 continue;
3796
3797 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
3798 {
3799 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first location.
3800 The watchpoint_check function will work on entire expression,
3801 not the individual locations. For read watchopints, the
3802 watchpoints_triggered function have checked all locations
3803 already. */
3804 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
3805 break;
3806
3807 if (bl->shlib_disabled)
3808 continue;
3809
3810 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
3811 continue;
3812
3813 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address matches */
3814
3815 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, bs); /* Alloc a bpstat to explain stop */
3816
3817 /* Assume we stop. Should we find watchpoint that is not actually
3818 triggered, or if condition of breakpoint is false, we'll reset
3819 'stop' to 0. */
3820 bs->stop = 1;
3821 bs->print = 1;
3822
3823 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
3824 if (!bs->stop)
3825 continue;
3826
3827 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3828 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
3829 /* We do not stop for these. */
3830 bs->stop = 0;
3831 else
3832 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
3833
3834 if (bs->stop)
3835 {
3836 ++(b->hit_count);
3837
3838 /* We will stop here */
3839 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
3840 {
3841 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
3842 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3843 update_global_location_list (0);
3844 }
3845 if (b->silent)
3846 bs->print = 0;
3847 bs->commands = b->commands;
3848 if (bs->commands
3849 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands->line) == 0
3850 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q",
3851 bs->commands->line) == 0)))
3852 {
3853 bs->commands = bs->commands->next;
3854 bs->print = 0;
3855 }
3856 bs->commands = copy_command_lines (bs->commands);
3857 }
3858
3859 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or dont print. */
3860 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
3861 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3862 }
3863 }
3864
3865 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
3866 {
3867 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
3868 aspace, bp_addr))
3869 {
3870 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, bs);
3871 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
3872 bs->stop = 0;
3873 bs->print = 0;
3874 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3875 }
3876 }
3877
3878 bs->next = NULL; /* Terminate the chain */
3879
3880 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
3881 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
3882 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
3883 done later. */
3884 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3885 if (bs->stop)
3886 break;
3887
3888 need_remove_insert = 0;
3889 if (bs == NULL)
3890 for (bs = root_bs->next; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3891 if (!bs->stop
3892 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
3893 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner))
3894 {
3895 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
3896 /* Updating watchpoints invalidates bs->breakpoint_at.
3897 Prevent further code from trying to use it. */
3898 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
3899 need_remove_insert = 1;
3900 }
3901
3902 if (need_remove_insert)
3903 update_global_location_list (1);
3904
3905 return root_bs->next;
3906 }
3907 \f
3908 /* Tell what to do about this bpstat. */
3909 struct bpstat_what
3910 bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
3911 {
3912 /* Classify each bpstat as one of the following. */
3913 enum class
3914 {
3915 /* This bpstat element has no effect on the main_action. */
3916 no_effect = 0,
3917
3918 /* There was a watchpoint, stop but don't print. */
3919 wp_silent,
3920
3921 /* There was a watchpoint, stop and print. */
3922 wp_noisy,
3923
3924 /* There was a breakpoint but we're not stopping. */
3925 bp_nostop,
3926
3927 /* There was a breakpoint, stop but don't print. */
3928 bp_silent,
3929
3930 /* There was a breakpoint, stop and print. */
3931 bp_noisy,
3932
3933 /* We hit the longjmp breakpoint. */
3934 long_jump,
3935
3936 /* We hit the longjmp_resume breakpoint. */
3937 long_resume,
3938
3939 /* We hit the step_resume breakpoint. */
3940 step_resume,
3941
3942 /* We hit the shared library event breakpoint. */
3943 shlib_event,
3944
3945 /* We hit the jit event breakpoint. */
3946 jit_event,
3947
3948 /* This is just used to count how many enums there are. */
3949 class_last
3950 };
3951
3952 /* Here is the table which drives this routine. So that we can
3953 format it pretty, we define some abbreviations for the
3954 enum bpstat_what codes. */
3955 #define kc BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING
3956 #define ss BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT
3957 #define sn BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3958 #define sgl BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE
3959 #define slr BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME
3960 #define clr BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME
3961 #define sr BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME
3962 #define shl BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_SHLIBS
3963 #define jit BPSTAT_WHAT_CHECK_JIT
3964
3965 /* "Can't happen." Might want to print an error message.
3966 abort() is not out of the question, but chances are GDB is just
3967 a bit confused, not unusable. */
3968 #define err BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY
3969
3970 /* Given an old action and a class, come up with a new action. */
3971 /* One interesting property of this table is that wp_silent is the same
3972 as bp_silent and wp_noisy is the same as bp_noisy. That is because
3973 after stopping, the check for whether to step over a breakpoint
3974 (BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE type stuff) is handled in proceed() without
3975 reference to how we stopped. We retain separate wp_silent and
3976 bp_silent codes in case we want to change that someday.
3977
3978 Another possibly interesting property of this table is that
3979 there's a partial ordering, priority-like, of the actions. Once
3980 you've decided that some action is appropriate, you'll never go
3981 back and decide something of a lower priority is better. The
3982 ordering is:
3983
3984 kc < jit clr sgl shl slr sn sr ss
3985 sgl < jit shl slr sn sr ss
3986 slr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3987 clr < jit err shl sn sr ss
3988 ss < jit shl sn sr
3989 sn < jit shl sr
3990 jit < shl sr
3991 shl < sr
3992 sr <
3993
3994 What I think this means is that we don't need a damned table
3995 here. If you just put the rows and columns in the right order,
3996 it'd look awfully regular. We could simply walk the bpstat list
3997 and choose the highest priority action we find, with a little
3998 logic to handle the 'err' cases. */
3999
4000 /* step_resume entries: a step resume breakpoint overrides another
4001 breakpoint of signal handling (see comment in wait_for_inferior
4002 at where we set the step_resume breakpoint). */
4003
4004 static const enum bpstat_what_main_action
4005 table[(int) class_last][(int) BPSTAT_WHAT_LAST] =
4006 {
4007 /* old action */
4008 /* kc ss sn sgl slr clr sr shl jit */
4009 /* no_effect */ {kc, ss, sn, sgl, slr, clr, sr, shl, jit},
4010 /* wp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
4011 /* wp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
4012 /* bp_nostop */ {sgl, ss, sn, sgl, slr, slr, sr, shl, jit},
4013 /* bp_silent */ {ss, ss, sn, ss, ss, ss, sr, shl, jit},
4014 /* bp_noisy */ {sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sn, sr, shl, jit},
4015 /* long_jump */ {slr, ss, sn, slr, slr, err, sr, shl, jit},
4016 /* long_resume */ {clr, ss, sn, err, err, err, sr, shl, jit},
4017 /* step_resume */ {sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr, sr },
4018 /* shlib */ {shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, shl, sr, shl, shl},
4019 /* jit_event */ {jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, jit, sr, jit, jit}
4020 };
4021
4022 #undef kc
4023 #undef ss
4024 #undef sn
4025 #undef sgl
4026 #undef slr
4027 #undef clr
4028 #undef err
4029 #undef sr
4030 #undef ts
4031 #undef shl
4032 #undef jit
4033 enum bpstat_what_main_action current_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
4034 struct bpstat_what retval;
4035
4036 retval.call_dummy = 0;
4037 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4038 {
4039 enum class bs_class = no_effect;
4040 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4041 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary breakpoint
4042 which has since been deleted. */
4043 continue;
4044 if (bs->breakpoint_at->owner == NULL)
4045 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4046 else
4047 switch (bs->breakpoint_at->owner->type)
4048 {
4049 case bp_none:
4050 continue;
4051
4052 case bp_breakpoint:
4053 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4054 case bp_until:
4055 case bp_finish:
4056 if (bs->stop)
4057 {
4058 if (bs->print)
4059 bs_class = bp_noisy;
4060 else
4061 bs_class = bp_silent;
4062 }
4063 else
4064 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4065 break;
4066 case bp_watchpoint:
4067 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4068 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4069 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4070 if (bs->stop)
4071 {
4072 if (bs->print)
4073 bs_class = wp_noisy;
4074 else
4075 bs_class = wp_silent;
4076 }
4077 else
4078 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4079 This requires no further action. */
4080 bs_class = no_effect;
4081 break;
4082 case bp_longjmp:
4083 bs_class = long_jump;
4084 break;
4085 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4086 bs_class = long_resume;
4087 break;
4088 case bp_step_resume:
4089 if (bs->stop)
4090 {
4091 bs_class = step_resume;
4092 }
4093 else
4094 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
4095 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4096 break;
4097 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4098 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4099 break;
4100 case bp_shlib_event:
4101 bs_class = shlib_event;
4102 break;
4103 case bp_jit_event:
4104 bs_class = jit_event;
4105 break;
4106 case bp_thread_event:
4107 case bp_overlay_event:
4108 case bp_longjmp_master:
4109 bs_class = bp_nostop;
4110 break;
4111 case bp_catchpoint:
4112 if (bs->stop)
4113 {
4114 if (bs->print)
4115 bs_class = bp_noisy;
4116 else
4117 bs_class = bp_silent;
4118 }
4119 else
4120 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4121 This requires no further action. */
4122 bs_class = no_effect;
4123 break;
4124 case bp_call_dummy:
4125 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
4126 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
4127 bs_class = bp_silent;
4128 retval.call_dummy = 1;
4129 break;
4130 case bp_tracepoint:
4131 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4132 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
4133 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
4134 out already. */
4135 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4136 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
4137 break;
4138 }
4139 current_action = table[(int) bs_class][(int) current_action];
4140 }
4141 retval.main_action = current_action;
4142 return retval;
4143 }
4144
4145 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
4146 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
4147 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
4148
4149 int
4150 bpstat_should_step (void)
4151 {
4152 struct breakpoint *b;
4153 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4154 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
4155 return 1;
4156 return 0;
4157 }
4158
4159 int
4160 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
4161 {
4162 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4163 if (bs->stop)
4164 return 1;
4165
4166 return 0;
4167 }
4168
4169 \f
4170
4171 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
4172
4173 static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4174 struct bp_location *loc,
4175 char *wrap_indent,
4176 struct ui_stream *stb)
4177 {
4178 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
4179
4180 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
4181 loc = NULL;
4182
4183 if (loc != NULL)
4184 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
4185
4186 if (b->source_file && loc)
4187 {
4188 struct symbol *sym
4189 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
4190 if (sym)
4191 {
4192 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
4193 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
4194 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
4195 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
4196 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
4197 }
4198 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
4199 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
4200
4201 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4202 {
4203 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
4204 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
4205
4206 if (fullname)
4207 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
4208 }
4209
4210 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
4211 }
4212 else if (loc)
4213 {
4214 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb->stream,
4215 demangle, "");
4216 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
4217 }
4218 else
4219 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
4220
4221 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4222 }
4223
4224 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
4225 static void
4226 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4227 struct bp_location *loc,
4228 int loc_number,
4229 struct bp_location **last_loc,
4230 int print_address_bits,
4231 int allflag)
4232 {
4233 struct command_line *l;
4234 struct symbol *sym;
4235 struct ep_type_description
4236 {
4237 enum bptype type;
4238 char *description;
4239 };
4240 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4241 {
4242 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4243 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4244 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4245 {bp_until, "until"},
4246 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4247 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4248 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4249 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4250 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4251 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4252 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4253 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4254 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4255 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4256 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4257 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4258 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4259 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4260 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4261 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4262 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
4263 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4264 };
4265
4266 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4267 char wrap_indent[80];
4268 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4269 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4270 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4271
4272 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4273 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4274 struct value_print_options opts;
4275
4276 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4277
4278 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4279 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning
4280 treatment of breakpoints with single disabled
4281 location. */
4282 if (loc == NULL
4283 && (b->loc != NULL
4284 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4285 header_of_multiple = 1;
4286 if (loc == NULL)
4287 loc = b->loc;
4288
4289 annotate_record ();
4290 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4291
4292 /* 1 */
4293 annotate_field (0);
4294 if (part_of_multiple)
4295 {
4296 char *formatted;
4297 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4298 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4299 xfree (formatted);
4300 }
4301 else
4302 {
4303 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4304 }
4305
4306 /* 2 */
4307 annotate_field (1);
4308 if (part_of_multiple)
4309 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4310 else
4311 {
4312 if (((int) b->type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4313 || ((int) b->type != bptypes[(int) b->type].type))
4314 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4315 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4316 (int) b->type);
4317 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptypes[(int) b->type].description);
4318 }
4319
4320 /* 3 */
4321 annotate_field (2);
4322 if (part_of_multiple)
4323 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4324 else
4325 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4326
4327
4328 /* 4 */
4329 annotate_field (3);
4330 if (part_of_multiple)
4331 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4332 else
4333 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4334 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4335 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4336
4337
4338 /* 5 and 6 */
4339 strcpy (wrap_indent, " ");
4340 if (opts.addressprint)
4341 {
4342 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4343 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4344 else
4345 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4346 }
4347
4348 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4349 {
4350 /* Although the print_one can possibly print
4351 all locations, calling it here is not likely
4352 to get any nice result. So, make sure there's
4353 just one location. */
4354 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4355 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4356 }
4357 else
4358 switch (b->type)
4359 {
4360 case bp_none:
4361 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4362 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4363 break;
4364
4365 case bp_watchpoint:
4366 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4367 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4368 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4369 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4370 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4371 is relatively readable). */
4372 if (opts.addressprint)
4373 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4374 annotate_field (5);
4375 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4376 break;
4377
4378 case bp_breakpoint:
4379 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4380 case bp_until:
4381 case bp_finish:
4382 case bp_longjmp:
4383 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4384 case bp_step_resume:
4385 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4386 case bp_call_dummy:
4387 case bp_shlib_event:
4388 case bp_thread_event:
4389 case bp_overlay_event:
4390 case bp_longjmp_master:
4391 case bp_tracepoint:
4392 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4393 case bp_jit_event:
4394 if (opts.addressprint)
4395 {
4396 annotate_field (4);
4397 if (header_of_multiple)
4398 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4399 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4400 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4401 else
4402 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4403 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4404 }
4405 annotate_field (5);
4406 if (!header_of_multiple)
4407 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4408 if (b->loc)
4409 *last_loc = b->loc;
4410 break;
4411 }
4412
4413
4414 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4415 are several. */
4416 if (loc != NULL
4417 && !header_of_multiple
4418 && (allflag
4419 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4420 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4421 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4422 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4423 {
4424 struct inferior *inf;
4425 int first = 1;
4426
4427 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4428 {
4429 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4430 {
4431 if (first)
4432 {
4433 first = 0;
4434 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4435 }
4436 else
4437 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4438 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4439 }
4440 }
4441 }
4442
4443 if (!part_of_multiple)
4444 {
4445 if (b->thread != -1)
4446 {
4447 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4448 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4449 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4450 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4451 }
4452 else if (b->task != 0)
4453 {
4454 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4455 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4456 }
4457 }
4458
4459 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4460
4461 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4462 {
4463 annotate_field (6);
4464 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4465 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4466 the frame ID. */
4467 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4468 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4469 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4470 }
4471
4472 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4473 {
4474 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4475 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4476 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4477 annotate_field (7);
4478 if (tracepoint_type (b))
4479 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4480 else
4481 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4482 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4483 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4484 }
4485
4486 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4487 {
4488 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4489 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4490 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4491 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4492 }
4493
4494 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4495 {
4496 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this */
4497 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4498 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4499 else
4500 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4501 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4502 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4503 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4504 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4505 else
4506 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4507 }
4508
4509 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is
4510 mi. FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4511 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4512 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4513 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4514
4515 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4516 {
4517 annotate_field (8);
4518 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4519 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4520 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4521 }
4522
4523 l = b->commands;
4524 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4525 {
4526 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4527
4528 annotate_field (9);
4529 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4530 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4531 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4532 }
4533
4534 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4535 {
4536 annotate_field (10);
4537 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4538 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4539 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4540 }
4541
4542 if (!part_of_multiple && b->step_count)
4543 {
4544 annotate_field (11);
4545 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstep count ");
4546 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "step", b->step_count);
4547 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4548 }
4549
4550 if (!part_of_multiple && b->actions)
4551 {
4552 struct action_line *action;
4553 annotate_field (12);
4554 for (action = b->actions; action; action = action->next)
4555 {
4556 ui_out_text (uiout, " A\t");
4557 ui_out_text (uiout, action->action);
4558 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4559 }
4560 }
4561
4562 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4563 {
4564 if (b->addr_string)
4565 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4566 else if (b->exp_string)
4567 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4568 }
4569
4570 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4571 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4572 }
4573
4574 static void
4575 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4576 struct bp_location **last_loc, int print_address_bits,
4577 int allflag)
4578 {
4579 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4580 print_address_bits, allflag);
4581
4582 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4583 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
4584 locations, if any. */
4585 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4586 {
4587 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is
4588 disabled, we print it as if it had
4589 several locations, since otherwise it's hard to
4590 represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4591 situation.
4592 Note that while hardware watchpoints have
4593 several locations internally, that's no a property
4594 exposed to user. */
4595 if (b->loc
4596 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4597 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4598 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4599 {
4600 struct bp_location *loc;
4601 int n = 1;
4602 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4603 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4604 print_address_bits, allflag);
4605 }
4606 }
4607 }
4608
4609 static int
4610 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4611 {
4612 int print_address_bits = 0;
4613 struct bp_location *loc;
4614
4615 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4616 {
4617 int addr_bit;
4618
4619 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have
4620 an address to print. */
4621 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && loc->watchpoint_type == -1)
4622 continue;
4623
4624 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4625 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4626 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4627 }
4628
4629 return print_address_bits;
4630 }
4631
4632 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4633 {
4634 int bnum;
4635 };
4636
4637 static int
4638 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4639 {
4640 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4641 struct breakpoint *b;
4642 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4643 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4644 {
4645 if (args->bnum == b->number)
4646 {
4647 int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4648 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4649 return GDB_RC_OK;
4650 }
4651 }
4652 return GDB_RC_NONE;
4653 }
4654
4655 enum gdb_rc
4656 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum, char **error_message)
4657 {
4658 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4659 args.bnum = bnum;
4660 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
4661 an error. */
4662 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
4663 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
4664 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
4665 else
4666 return GDB_RC_OK;
4667 }
4668
4669 /* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
4670 catchpoints, et.al.). */
4671
4672 static int
4673 user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
4674 {
4675 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
4676 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
4677 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
4678 || tracepoint_type (b)
4679 || b->type == bp_watchpoint
4680 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
4681 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint
4682 || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint);
4683 }
4684
4685 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
4686 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user settable breakpoints.
4687 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non- user settable breakpoints. */
4688
4689 static void
4690 breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag)
4691 {
4692 struct breakpoint *b;
4693 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
4694 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
4695 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
4696 struct value_print_options opts;
4697 int print_address_bits = 0;
4698
4699 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4700
4701 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the
4702 size required for address fields. */
4703 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
4704 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4705 if (bnum == -1
4706 || bnum == b->number)
4707 {
4708 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4709 {
4710 int addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4711 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4712 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4713
4714 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
4715 }
4716 }
4717
4718 if (opts.addressprint)
4719 bkpttbl_chain
4720 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4721 "BreakpointTable");
4722 else
4723 bkpttbl_chain
4724 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
4725 "BreakpointTable");
4726
4727 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4728 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
4729 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4730 annotate_field (0);
4731 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
4732 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4733 annotate_field (1);
4734 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 14, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
4735 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4736 annotate_field (2);
4737 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
4738 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4739 annotate_field (3);
4740 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
4741 if (opts.addressprint)
4742 {
4743 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4744 annotate_field (4);
4745 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4746 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4747 else
4748 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left, "addr", "Address");/* 5 */
4749 }
4750 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4751 annotate_field (5);
4752 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
4753 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
4754 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
4755 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
4756
4757 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4758 {
4759 QUIT;
4760 if (bnum == -1
4761 || bnum == b->number)
4762 {
4763 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
4764 allflag is set. */
4765 if (allflag || user_settable_breakpoint (b))
4766 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
4767 }
4768 }
4769
4770 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
4771
4772 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
4773 {
4774 if (bnum == -1)
4775 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
4776 else
4777 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
4778 bnum);
4779 }
4780 else
4781 {
4782 if (last_loc && !server_command)
4783 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
4784 }
4785
4786 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
4787 there have been breakpoints? */
4788 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
4789 }
4790
4791 static void
4792 breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4793 {
4794 int bnum = -1;
4795
4796 if (bnum_exp)
4797 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4798
4799 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0);
4800 }
4801
4802 static void
4803 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
4804 {
4805 int bnum = -1;
4806
4807 if (bnum_exp)
4808 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
4809
4810 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1);
4811 }
4812
4813 static int
4814 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
4815 struct program_space *pspace,
4816 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
4817 {
4818 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
4819 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
4820 {
4821 if (bl->pspace == pspace
4822 && bl->address == pc
4823 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
4824 return 1;
4825 }
4826 return 0;
4827 }
4828
4829 /* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
4830 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
4831 address spaces. */
4832
4833 static void
4834 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4835 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
4836 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
4837 {
4838 int others = 0;
4839 struct breakpoint *b;
4840
4841 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4842 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
4843 if (others > 0)
4844 {
4845 if (others == 1)
4846 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
4847 else /* if (others == ???) */
4848 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
4849 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4850 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
4851 {
4852 others--;
4853 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
4854 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
4855 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
4856 else if (b->thread != -1)
4857 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
4858 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
4859 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
4860 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
4861 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
4862 ? " (disabled)"
4863 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
4864 ? " (permanent)"
4865 : ""),
4866 (others > 1) ? ","
4867 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
4868 }
4869 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
4870 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
4871 printf_filtered (".\n");
4872 }
4873 }
4874 \f
4875 /* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
4876 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
4877
4878 void
4879 set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
4880 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
4881 int line)
4882 {
4883 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
4884 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
4885 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
4886 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
4887 default_breakpoint_line = line;
4888 }
4889
4890 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
4891 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
4892 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
4893 (or use it for any other purpose either).
4894
4895 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will always
4896 have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of
4897 these types to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint at address zero:
4898
4899 bp_watchpoint
4900 bp_catchpoint
4901
4902 */
4903
4904 static int
4905 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
4906 {
4907 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
4908
4909 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
4910 }
4911
4912 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
4913 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
4914
4915 static int
4916 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4917 {
4918 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
4919 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
4920 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
4921 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
4922 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
4923 become hw_access locations later. */
4924 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
4925 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
4926 && loc1->address == loc2->address
4927 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
4928 }
4929
4930 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
4931 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
4932 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
4933 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
4934
4935 static int
4936 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
4937 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
4938 {
4939 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4940 || aspace1 == aspace2)
4941 && addr1 == addr2);
4942 }
4943
4944 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
4945 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
4946 represent the same location. */
4947
4948 static int
4949 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1, struct bp_location *loc2)
4950 {
4951 int hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
4952 int hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
4953
4954 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
4955 return 0;
4956 else if (hw_point1)
4957 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
4958 else
4959 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
4960 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
4961 }
4962
4963 static void
4964 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
4965 int bnum, int have_bnum)
4966 {
4967 char astr1[40];
4968 char astr2[40];
4969
4970 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
4971 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
4972 if (have_bnum)
4973 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
4974 bnum, astr1, astr2);
4975 else
4976 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
4977 }
4978
4979 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural constraints
4980 on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. Note: Very
4981 few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most targets,
4982 this function is simply the identity function. */
4983
4984 static CORE_ADDR
4985 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
4986 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
4987 {
4988 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
4989 {
4990 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
4991 return bpaddr;
4992 }
4993 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
4994 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
4995 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
4996 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
4997 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
4998 {
4999 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
5000 have their addresses modified. */
5001 return bpaddr;
5002 }
5003 else
5004 {
5005 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
5006
5007 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
5008 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
5009 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
5010
5011 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
5012 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
5013 is required. */
5014 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
5015 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
5016
5017 return adjusted_bpaddr;
5018 }
5019 }
5020
5021 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
5022
5023 static struct bp_location *
5024 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
5025 {
5026 struct bp_location *loc, *loc_p;
5027
5028 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
5029 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
5030
5031 loc->owner = bpt;
5032 loc->cond = NULL;
5033 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
5034 loc->enabled = 1;
5035
5036 switch (bpt->type)
5037 {
5038 case bp_breakpoint:
5039 case bp_until:
5040 case bp_finish:
5041 case bp_longjmp:
5042 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5043 case bp_step_resume:
5044 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5045 case bp_call_dummy:
5046 case bp_shlib_event:
5047 case bp_thread_event:
5048 case bp_overlay_event:
5049 case bp_jit_event:
5050 case bp_longjmp_master:
5051 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
5052 break;
5053 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5054 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
5055 break;
5056 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5057 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5058 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5059 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
5060 break;
5061 case bp_watchpoint:
5062 case bp_catchpoint:
5063 case bp_tracepoint:
5064 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5065 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
5066 break;
5067 default:
5068 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
5069 }
5070
5071 return loc;
5072 }
5073
5074 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
5075 {
5076 if (loc->cond)
5077 xfree (loc->cond);
5078
5079 if (loc->function_name)
5080 xfree (loc->function_name);
5081
5082 xfree (loc);
5083 }
5084
5085 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
5086 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
5087 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made static. */
5088
5089 static struct breakpoint *
5090 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5091 enum bptype bptype)
5092 {
5093 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
5094
5095 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
5096 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
5097
5098 b->type = bptype;
5099 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
5100 b->language = current_language->la_language;
5101 b->input_radix = input_radix;
5102 b->thread = -1;
5103 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5104 b->next = 0;
5105 b->silent = 0;
5106 b->ignore_count = 0;
5107 b->commands = NULL;
5108 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
5109 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5110 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
5111 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
5112 b->ops = NULL;
5113 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
5114
5115 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain
5116 so that a list of breakpoints will come out in order
5117 of increasing numbers. */
5118
5119 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
5120 if (b1 == 0)
5121 breakpoint_chain = b;
5122 else
5123 {
5124 while (b1->next)
5125 b1 = b1->next;
5126 b1->next = b;
5127 }
5128 return b;
5129 }
5130
5131 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
5132 static void
5133 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
5134 {
5135 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
5136 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
5137 || tracepoint_type (loc->owner))
5138 {
5139 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
5140 NULL, NULL);
5141 if (loc->function_name)
5142 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
5143 }
5144 }
5145
5146 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
5147 static struct gdbarch *
5148 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
5149 {
5150 if (sal.section)
5151 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
5152 if (sal.symtab)
5153 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
5154
5155 return NULL;
5156 }
5157
5158 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
5159 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
5160 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
5161 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
5162 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
5163 is also returned as the value of this function.
5164
5165 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
5166 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
5167 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
5168 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
5169 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
5170 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
5171 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
5172
5173 struct breakpoint *
5174 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5175 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
5176 {
5177 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, bptype);
5178 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
5179 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
5180
5181 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
5182 if (!loc_gdbarch)
5183 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
5184
5185 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
5186 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
5187
5188 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
5189 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
5190 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
5191 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
5192 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
5193 location that's only been partially initialized. */
5194 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, sal.pc, b->type);
5195
5196 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
5197 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
5198 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
5199 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
5200 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
5201
5202 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
5203 breakpoint resetting. */
5204 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
5205
5206 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
5207 b->source_file = NULL;
5208 else
5209 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
5210 b->loc->section = sal.section;
5211 b->line_number = sal.line;
5212
5213 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
5214
5215 breakpoints_changed ();
5216
5217 return b;
5218 }
5219
5220
5221 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
5222 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
5223 void
5224 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
5225 {
5226 struct bp_location *bl;
5227 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
5228
5229 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the code.
5230 Mark all locations as inserted. For now, make_breakpoint_permanent
5231 is called in just one place, so it's hard to say if it's reasonable
5232 to have permanent breakpoint with multiple locations or not,
5233 but it's easy to implmement. */
5234 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5235 bl->inserted = 1;
5236 }
5237
5238 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
5239 if we do a longjmp() in THREAD. When we hit that breakpoint, call
5240 set_longjmp_resume_breakpoint() to figure out where we are going. */
5241
5242 void
5243 set_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5244 {
5245 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5246
5247 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
5248 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
5249 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
5250 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
5251 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5252 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5253 && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
5254 {
5255 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5256 clone->type = bp_longjmp;
5257 clone->thread = thread;
5258 }
5259 }
5260
5261 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5262 void
5263 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5264 {
5265 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5266
5267 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5268 if (b->type == bp_longjmp)
5269 {
5270 if (b->thread == thread)
5271 delete_breakpoint (b);
5272 }
5273 }
5274
5275 void
5276 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5277 {
5278 struct breakpoint *b;
5279
5280 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5281 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5282 {
5283 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5284 update_global_location_list (1);
5285 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5286 }
5287 }
5288
5289 void
5290 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5291 {
5292 struct breakpoint *b;
5293
5294 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5295 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5296 {
5297 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5298 update_global_location_list (0);
5299 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5300 }
5301 }
5302
5303 struct breakpoint *
5304 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5305 {
5306 struct breakpoint *b;
5307
5308 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5309
5310 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5311 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5312 b->addr_string
5313 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5314
5315 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5316
5317 return b;
5318 }
5319
5320 void
5321 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5322 {
5323 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5324
5325 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5326 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5327 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5328 delete_breakpoint (b);
5329 }
5330
5331 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5332 {
5333 char **arg_p;
5334 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5335 char ***addr_string_p;
5336 int *not_found_ptr;
5337 };
5338
5339 struct lang_and_radix
5340 {
5341 enum language lang;
5342 int radix;
5343 };
5344
5345 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5346
5347 struct breakpoint *
5348 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5349 {
5350 struct breakpoint *b;
5351
5352 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5353 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5354 return b;
5355 }
5356
5357 void
5358 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5359 {
5360 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
5361
5362 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
5363 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5364 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5365 delete_breakpoint (b);
5366 }
5367
5368 struct breakpoint *
5369 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5370 {
5371 struct breakpoint *b;
5372
5373 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5374 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5375 return b;
5376 }
5377
5378 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
5379 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5380
5381 void
5382 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5383 {
5384 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5385
5386 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5387 {
5388 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5389 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled
5390 for those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
5391 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to insert
5392 all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here, we'll try
5393 to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
5394 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5395 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5396 || (tracepoint_type (b)))
5397 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5398 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5399 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
5400 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5401 #else
5402 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5403 #endif
5404 )
5405 {
5406 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5407 }
5408 }
5409 }
5410
5411 /* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library. Only
5412 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5413
5414 static void
5415 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5416 {
5417 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5418 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5419
5420 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5421 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5422 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5423 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
5424 if (exec_bfd != NULL
5425 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5426 return;
5427
5428 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5429 {
5430 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5431 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5432 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5433 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5434 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5435 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5436 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5437 {
5438 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5439 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5440 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5441 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
5442 loc->inserted = 0;
5443 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5444 {
5445 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5446 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5447 solib->so_name);
5448 }
5449 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5450 }
5451 }
5452 }
5453
5454 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
5455
5456 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5457
5458 static void
5459 insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5460 {
5461 target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5462 }
5463
5464 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5465
5466 static int
5467 remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5468 {
5469 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5470 }
5471
5472 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5473 catchpoints. */
5474
5475 static int
5476 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5477 {
5478 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5479 }
5480
5481 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5482
5483 static enum print_stop_action
5484 print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5485 {
5486 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5487 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
5488 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5489 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5490 }
5491
5492 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork catchpoints. */
5493
5494 static void
5495 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5496 {
5497 struct value_print_options opts;
5498
5499 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5500
5501 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5502 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5503 is relatively readable). */
5504 if (opts.addressprint)
5505 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5506 annotate_field (5);
5507 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
5508 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5509 {
5510 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5511 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5512 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5513 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5514 }
5515 }
5516
5517 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5518 catchpoints. */
5519
5520 static void
5521 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5522 {
5523 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
5524 }
5525
5526 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
5527
5528 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
5529 {
5530 insert_catch_fork,
5531 remove_catch_fork,
5532 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
5533 print_it_catch_fork,
5534 print_one_catch_fork,
5535 print_mention_catch_fork
5536 };
5537
5538 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5539
5540 static void
5541 insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5542 {
5543 target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5544 }
5545
5546 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5547
5548 static int
5549 remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5550 {
5551 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5552 }
5553
5554 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5555 catchpoints. */
5556
5557 static int
5558 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5559 {
5560 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
5561 }
5562
5563 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5564
5565 static enum print_stop_action
5566 print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5567 {
5568 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5569 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
5570 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5571 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5572 }
5573
5574 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork catchpoints. */
5575
5576 static void
5577 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5578 {
5579 struct value_print_options opts;
5580
5581 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5582 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5583 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5584 is relatively readable). */
5585 if (opts.addressprint)
5586 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5587 annotate_field (5);
5588 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
5589 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
5590 {
5591 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
5592 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
5593 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
5594 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
5595 }
5596 }
5597
5598 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
5599 catchpoints. */
5600
5601 static void
5602 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
5603 {
5604 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
5605 }
5606
5607 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
5608
5609 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
5610 {
5611 insert_catch_vfork,
5612 remove_catch_vfork,
5613 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
5614 print_it_catch_vfork,
5615 print_one_catch_vfork,
5616 print_mention_catch_vfork
5617 };
5618
5619 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5620 catchpoints. */
5621
5622 static void
5623 insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5624 {
5625 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5626
5627 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
5628 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5629 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
5630 else
5631 {
5632 int i, iter;
5633 for (i = 0;
5634 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5635 i++)
5636 {
5637 int elem;
5638 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5639 {
5640 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
5641 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
5642 uintptr_t vec_addr;
5643 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
5644 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
5645 vec_addr_offset;
5646 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
5647 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
5648 }
5649 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5650 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
5651 }
5652 }
5653
5654 target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5655 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5656 inf->any_syscall_count,
5657 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5658 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5659 }
5660
5661 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5662 catchpoints. */
5663
5664 static int
5665 remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5666 {
5667 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
5668
5669 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
5670 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5671 --inf->any_syscall_count;
5672 else
5673 {
5674 int i, iter;
5675 for (i = 0;
5676 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5677 i++)
5678 {
5679 int elem;
5680 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
5681 /* Shouldn't happen. */
5682 continue;
5683 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
5684 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
5685 }
5686 }
5687
5688 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
5689 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
5690 inf->any_syscall_count,
5691 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
5692 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
5693 }
5694
5695 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5696 catchpoints. */
5697
5698 static int
5699 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5700 {
5701 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this breakpoint.
5702 If we are, then we must guarantee that the called syscall is the same
5703 syscall we are catching. */
5704 int syscall_number = 0;
5705
5706 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
5707 return 0;
5708
5709 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
5710 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5711 {
5712 int i, iter;
5713 for (i = 0;
5714 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5715 i++)
5716 if (syscall_number == iter)
5717 break;
5718 /* Not the same. */
5719 if (!iter)
5720 return 0;
5721 }
5722
5723 return 1;
5724 }
5725
5726 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5727 catchpoints. */
5728
5729 static enum print_stop_action
5730 print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5731 {
5732 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
5733 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
5734 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
5735 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
5736 ptid_t ptid;
5737 struct target_waitstatus last;
5738 struct syscall s;
5739 struct cleanup *old_chain;
5740 char *syscall_id;
5741
5742 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
5743
5744 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
5745
5746 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5747
5748 if (s.name == NULL)
5749 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
5750 else
5751 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
5752
5753 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
5754
5755 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
5756 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
5757 b->number, syscall_id);
5758 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
5759 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
5760 b->number, syscall_id);
5761
5762 do_cleanups (old_chain);
5763
5764 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5765 }
5766
5767 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5768 catchpoints. */
5769
5770 static void
5771 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
5772 struct bp_location **last_loc)
5773 {
5774 struct value_print_options opts;
5775
5776 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5777 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5778 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5779 is relatively readable). */
5780 if (opts.addressprint)
5781 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5782 annotate_field (5);
5783
5784 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
5785 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5786 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
5787 else
5788 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
5789
5790 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5791 {
5792 int i, iter;
5793 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
5794 for (i = 0;
5795 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5796 i++)
5797 {
5798 char *x = text;
5799 struct syscall s;
5800 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5801
5802 if (s.name != NULL)
5803 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
5804 else
5805 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
5806
5807 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
5808 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
5809 on every call. */
5810 xfree (x);
5811 }
5812 /* Remove the last comma. */
5813 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
5814 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
5815 }
5816 else
5817 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
5818 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5819 }
5820
5821 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
5822 catchpoints. */
5823
5824 static void
5825 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
5826 {
5827 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
5828 {
5829 int i, iter;
5830
5831 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
5832 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
5833 else
5834 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
5835
5836 for (i = 0;
5837 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
5838 i++)
5839 {
5840 struct syscall s;
5841 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
5842
5843 if (s.name)
5844 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
5845 else
5846 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
5847 }
5848 printf_filtered (")");
5849 }
5850 else
5851 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
5852 b->number);
5853 }
5854
5855 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
5856
5857 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
5858 {
5859 insert_catch_syscall,
5860 remove_catch_syscall,
5861 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
5862 print_it_catch_syscall,
5863 print_one_catch_syscall,
5864 print_mention_catch_syscall
5865 };
5866
5867 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
5868
5869 static int
5870 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
5871 {
5872 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
5873 }
5874
5875 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
5876 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
5877 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
5878 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
5879
5880 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5881 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5882 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5883 to the catchpoint. */
5884
5885 static struct breakpoint *
5886 create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5887 char *cond_string,
5888 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5889 {
5890 struct symtab_and_line sal;
5891 struct breakpoint *b;
5892
5893 init_sal (&sal);
5894 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
5895
5896 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
5897 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
5898 b->number = breakpoint_count;
5899
5900 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
5901 b->thread = -1;
5902 b->addr_string = NULL;
5903 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5904 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
5905 b->ops = ops;
5906
5907 return b;
5908 }
5909
5910 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
5911
5912 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
5913 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
5914 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
5915 to the catchpoint. */
5916
5917 static struct breakpoint *
5918 create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
5919 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5920 {
5921 struct breakpoint *b =
5922 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5923
5924 mention (b);
5925 update_global_location_list (1);
5926
5927 return b;
5928 }
5929
5930 static void
5931 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5932 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
5933 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
5934 {
5935 struct breakpoint *b
5936 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
5937
5938 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
5939 area. */
5940 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5941 }
5942
5943 /* Exec catchpoints. */
5944
5945 static void
5946 insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5947 {
5948 target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5949 }
5950
5951 static int
5952 remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5953 {
5954 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5955 }
5956
5957 static int
5958 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5959 {
5960 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
5961 }
5962
5963 static enum print_stop_action
5964 print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5965 {
5966 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
5967 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
5968 b->exec_pathname);
5969 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
5970 }
5971
5972 static void
5973 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
5974 {
5975 struct value_print_options opts;
5976
5977 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5978
5979 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
5980 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
5981 is relatively readable). */
5982 if (opts.addressprint)
5983 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
5984 annotate_field (5);
5985 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
5986 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
5987 {
5988 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
5989 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
5990 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
5991 }
5992 }
5993
5994 static void
5995 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
5996 {
5997 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
5998 }
5999
6000 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
6001 {
6002 insert_catch_exec,
6003 remove_catch_exec,
6004 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
6005 print_it_catch_exec,
6006 print_one_catch_exec,
6007 print_mention_catch_exec
6008 };
6009
6010 static void
6011 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
6012 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6013 {
6014 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
6015 struct breakpoint *b =
6016 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
6017
6018 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
6019
6020 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
6021 location list. */
6022 mention (b);
6023 update_global_location_list (1);
6024 }
6025
6026 static int
6027 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
6028 {
6029 struct breakpoint *b;
6030 int i = 0;
6031
6032 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6033 {
6034 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6035 i++;
6036 }
6037
6038 return i;
6039 }
6040
6041 static int
6042 hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
6043 {
6044 struct breakpoint *b;
6045 int i = 0;
6046
6047 *other_type_used = 0;
6048 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6049 {
6050 if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
6051 {
6052 if (b->type == type)
6053 i++;
6054 else if ((b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6055 || b->type == bp_read_watchpoint
6056 || b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
6057 *other_type_used = 1;
6058 }
6059 }
6060 return i;
6061 }
6062
6063 void
6064 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
6065 {
6066 struct breakpoint *b;
6067
6068 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6069 {
6070 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
6071 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
6072 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
6073 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
6074 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6075 {
6076 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
6077 update_global_location_list (0);
6078 }
6079 }
6080 }
6081
6082 void
6083 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
6084 {
6085 struct breakpoint *b;
6086
6087 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6088 {
6089 if (((b->type == bp_watchpoint)
6090 || (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
6091 || (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
6092 || (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint))
6093 && (b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled))
6094 {
6095 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6096 update_global_location_list (1);
6097 }
6098 }
6099 }
6100
6101 void
6102 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
6103 {
6104 struct breakpoint *b;
6105 int found = 0;
6106
6107 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6108 {
6109 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6110 continue;
6111
6112 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6113 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6114 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6115 {
6116 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6117 found = 1;
6118 }
6119 }
6120
6121 if (found)
6122 update_global_location_list (0);
6123
6124 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
6125 }
6126
6127 void
6128 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
6129 {
6130 struct breakpoint *b;
6131 int found = 0;
6132
6133 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
6134
6135 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6136 {
6137 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6138 continue;
6139
6140 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6141 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6142 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
6143 {
6144 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6145 found = 1;
6146 }
6147 }
6148
6149 if (found)
6150 breakpoint_re_set ();
6151 }
6152
6153
6154 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
6155 at address specified by SAL.
6156 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
6157
6158 struct breakpoint *
6159 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
6160 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
6161 {
6162 struct breakpoint *b;
6163
6164 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
6165 one. */
6166 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
6167
6168 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6169 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6170 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6171 b->frame_id = frame_id;
6172
6173 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we
6174 want momentary breakpoints to be active in only a
6175 single thread of control. */
6176 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
6177 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
6178
6179 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
6180
6181 return b;
6182 }
6183
6184 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
6185 ORIG is NULL. */
6186
6187 struct breakpoint *
6188 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
6189 {
6190 struct breakpoint *copy;
6191
6192 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
6193 if (orig == NULL)
6194 return NULL;
6195
6196 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
6197 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
6198 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
6199
6200 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
6201 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
6202 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
6203 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
6204 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
6205
6206 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
6207 copy->source_file = NULL;
6208 else
6209 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
6210
6211 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
6212 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
6213 copy->thread = orig->thread;
6214 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
6215
6216 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6217 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6218 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
6219
6220 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
6221 return copy;
6222 }
6223
6224 struct breakpoint *
6225 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
6226 enum bptype type)
6227 {
6228 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6229
6230 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
6231 sal.pc = pc;
6232 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
6233 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6234
6235 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
6236 }
6237 \f
6238
6239 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
6240
6241 static void
6242 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
6243 {
6244 int say_where = 0;
6245 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
6246 struct value_print_options opts;
6247
6248 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6249
6250 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
6251 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
6252 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
6253 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
6254 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
6255
6256 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6257 b->ops->print_mention (b);
6258 else
6259 switch (b->type)
6260 {
6261 case bp_none:
6262 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6263 break;
6264 case bp_watchpoint:
6265 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6266 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6267 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6268 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6269 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6270 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6271 break;
6272 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6273 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6274 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6275 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6276 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6277 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6278 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6279 break;
6280 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6281 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6282 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6283 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6284 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6285 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6286 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6287 break;
6288 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6289 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6290 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6291 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6292 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6293 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6294 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6295 break;
6296 case bp_breakpoint:
6297 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6298 {
6299 say_where = 0;
6300 break;
6301 }
6302 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6303 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6304 else
6305 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6306 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6307 say_where = 1;
6308 break;
6309 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6310 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6311 {
6312 say_where = 0;
6313 break;
6314 }
6315 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6316 say_where = 1;
6317 break;
6318 case bp_tracepoint:
6319 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6320 {
6321 say_where = 0;
6322 break;
6323 }
6324 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6325 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6326 say_where = 1;
6327 break;
6328 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6329 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6330 {
6331 say_where = 0;
6332 break;
6333 }
6334 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
6335 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6336 say_where = 1;
6337 break;
6338
6339 case bp_until:
6340 case bp_finish:
6341 case bp_longjmp:
6342 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6343 case bp_step_resume:
6344 case bp_call_dummy:
6345 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6346 case bp_shlib_event:
6347 case bp_thread_event:
6348 case bp_overlay_event:
6349 case bp_jit_event:
6350 case bp_longjmp_master:
6351 break;
6352 }
6353
6354 if (say_where)
6355 {
6356 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6357 single string. */
6358 if (b->loc == NULL)
6359 {
6360 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6361 }
6362 else
6363 {
6364 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6365 {
6366 printf_filtered (" at ");
6367 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6368 gdb_stdout);
6369 }
6370 if (b->source_file)
6371 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6372 b->source_file, b->line_number);
6373
6374 if (b->loc->next)
6375 {
6376 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6377 int n = 0;
6378 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6379 ++n;
6380 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6381 }
6382
6383 }
6384 }
6385 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6386 return;
6387 printf_filtered ("\n");
6388 }
6389 \f
6390
6391 static struct bp_location *
6392 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6393 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6394 {
6395 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6396
6397 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6398 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6399 ;
6400 *tmp = loc;
6401 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6402 if (!loc->gdbarch)
6403 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6404 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
6405 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
6406 loc->requested_address, b->type);
6407 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
6408 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
6409 loc->section = sal->section;
6410
6411 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
6412 return loc;
6413 }
6414 \f
6415
6416 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
6417 return 0 otherwise. */
6418
6419 static int
6420 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
6421 {
6422 int len;
6423 CORE_ADDR addr;
6424 const gdb_byte *brk;
6425 gdb_byte *target_mem;
6426 struct cleanup *cleanup;
6427 int retval = 0;
6428
6429 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
6430
6431 addr = loc->address;
6432 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
6433
6434 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
6435 if (brk == NULL)
6436 return 0;
6437
6438 target_mem = alloca (len);
6439
6440 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
6441 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
6442 breakpoints they are permanent. */
6443 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6444
6445 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
6446 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
6447
6448 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
6449 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
6450 retval = 1;
6451
6452 do_cleanups (cleanup);
6453
6454 return retval;
6455 }
6456
6457
6458
6459 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
6460 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
6461 as condition expression. */
6462
6463 static void
6464 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6465 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
6466 char *cond_string,
6467 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6468 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6469 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty, int enabled)
6470 {
6471 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
6472 int i;
6473
6474 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6475 {
6476 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
6477 int target_resources_ok =
6478 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
6479 i + 1, 0);
6480 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
6481 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
6482 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
6483 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
6484 }
6485
6486 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
6487
6488 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6489 {
6490 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
6491 struct bp_location *loc;
6492
6493 if (from_tty)
6494 {
6495 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
6496 if (!loc_gdbarch)
6497 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
6498
6499 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
6500 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
6501 }
6502
6503 if (i == 0)
6504 {
6505 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6506 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6507 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6508 b->thread = thread;
6509 b->task = task;
6510
6511 b->cond_string = cond_string;
6512 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
6513 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
6514 b->disposition = disposition;
6515
6516 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
6517
6518 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
6519 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
6520 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
6521 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6522
6523 loc = b->loc;
6524 }
6525 else
6526 {
6527 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
6528 }
6529
6530 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
6531 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
6532
6533 if (b->cond_string)
6534 {
6535 char *arg = b->cond_string;
6536 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
6537 if (*arg)
6538 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
6539 }
6540 }
6541
6542 if (addr_string)
6543 b->addr_string = addr_string;
6544 else
6545 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
6546 me. */
6547 b->addr_string
6548 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
6549
6550 b->ops = ops;
6551 mention (b);
6552 }
6553
6554 /* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
6555 elements to fill the void space. */
6556 static void
6557 remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
6558 {
6559 int i = index_to_remove+1;
6560 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
6561
6562 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
6563 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
6564
6565 --(sal->nelts);
6566 }
6567
6568 /* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
6569 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
6570 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
6571 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
6572 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
6573 single expanded sal, return the original.
6574
6575 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
6576 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
6577 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
6578 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
6579 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
6580
6581 static struct symtabs_and_lines
6582 expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
6583 {
6584 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
6585 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
6586 char *original_function = NULL;
6587 int found;
6588 int i;
6589 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6590
6591 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
6592 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
6593 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
6594 {
6595 expanded.nelts = 1;
6596 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6597 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6598 return expanded;
6599 }
6600
6601 sal.pc = 0;
6602
6603 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
6604
6605 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
6606
6607 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
6608
6609 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
6610 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
6611
6612 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
6613 {
6614 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
6615 past the function prologue if necessary. */
6616 xfree (expanded.sals);
6617 expanded.nelts = 1;
6618 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6619 sal.pc = original_pc;
6620 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6621 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
6622 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6623 return expanded;
6624 }
6625
6626 if (!sal.explicit_line)
6627 {
6628 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
6629 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6630 {
6631 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
6632 char *this_function;
6633
6634 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
6635 read memory. */
6636 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
6637
6638 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
6639 &func_addr, &func_end))
6640 {
6641 if (this_function
6642 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
6643 {
6644 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
6645 --i;
6646 }
6647 else if (func_addr == pc)
6648 {
6649 /* We're at beginning of a function, and should
6650 skip prologue. */
6651 struct symbol *sym = find_pc_function (pc);
6652 if (sym)
6653 expanded.sals[i] = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
6654 else
6655 {
6656 /* Since find_pc_partial_function returned true,
6657 we should really always find the section here. */
6658 struct obj_section *section = find_pc_section (pc);
6659 if (section)
6660 {
6661 struct gdbarch *gdbarch
6662 = get_objfile_arch (section->objfile);
6663 expanded.sals[i].pc
6664 = gdbarch_skip_prologue (gdbarch, pc);
6665 }
6666 }
6667 }
6668 }
6669 }
6670 }
6671 else
6672 {
6673 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6674 {
6675 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a
6676 line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
6677 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
6678 }
6679 }
6680
6681 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6682
6683 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
6684 {
6685 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero
6686 expanded sals then something is really wrong.
6687 Fix that by returnign the original sal. */
6688 xfree (expanded.sals);
6689 expanded.nelts = 1;
6690 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6691 sal.pc = original_pc;
6692 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
6693 return expanded;
6694 }
6695
6696 if (original_pc)
6697 {
6698 found = 0;
6699 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
6700 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
6701 {
6702 found = 1;
6703 break;
6704 }
6705 gdb_assert (found);
6706 }
6707
6708 return expanded;
6709 }
6710
6711 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
6712 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
6713 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
6714 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
6715 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
6716 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
6717 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
6718 we take just a single condition string.
6719
6720 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
6721 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
6722 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
6723 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
6724 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
6725
6726 static void
6727 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6728 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
6729 char *cond_string,
6730 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
6731 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
6732 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
6733 int enabled)
6734 {
6735 int i;
6736 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
6737 {
6738 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
6739 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
6740
6741 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
6742 cond_string, type, disposition,
6743 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty, enabled);
6744 }
6745 }
6746
6747 /* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
6748 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
6749 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
6750 address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
6751
6752 static void
6753 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
6754 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6755 char ***addr_string,
6756 int *not_found_ptr)
6757 {
6758 char *addr_start = *address;
6759 *addr_string = NULL;
6760 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
6761 breakpoint. */
6762 if ((*address) == NULL
6763 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
6764 {
6765 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
6766 {
6767 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6768 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
6769 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
6770 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
6771 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
6772 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
6773 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
6774 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
6775 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
6776
6777 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" where PC is
6778 the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure to set
6779 sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to expand the list of
6780 sals to include all other instances with the same symtab and line.
6781 */
6782 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6783
6784 sals->sals[0] = sal;
6785 sals->nelts = 1;
6786 }
6787 else
6788 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
6789 }
6790 else
6791 {
6792 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
6793 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). This
6794 should produce the results we want almost all of the time while
6795 leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
6796 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
6797 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
6798
6799 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
6800
6801 if (default_breakpoint_valid
6802 && (!cursal.symtab
6803 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
6804 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
6805 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
6806 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
6807 not_found_ptr);
6808 else
6809 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
6810 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
6811 }
6812 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
6813 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
6814 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
6815 if (addr_start != (*address))
6816 {
6817 int i;
6818 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6819 {
6820 /* Add the string if not present. */
6821 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
6822 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start, (*address) - addr_start);
6823 }
6824 }
6825 }
6826
6827
6828 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
6829 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
6830
6831 static void
6832 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
6833 char *address)
6834 {
6835 int i;
6836 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6837 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
6838 }
6839
6840 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
6841 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
6842 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
6843 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
6844 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
6845 it, etc. */
6846
6847 static void
6848 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6849 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
6850 {
6851 int i, rslt;
6852 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
6853 char *msg;
6854 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6855
6856 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
6857 {
6858 sal = &sals->sals[i];
6859
6860 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (gdbarch, sal->pc,
6861 NULL, &msg);
6862 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
6863
6864 if (!rslt)
6865 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
6866 paddress (gdbarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
6867
6868 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6869 }
6870 }
6871
6872 static void
6873 do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
6874 {
6875 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
6876
6877 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
6878 args->not_found_ptr);
6879 }
6880
6881 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
6882 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
6883 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
6884 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
6885 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
6886 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
6887 static void
6888 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
6889 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
6890 {
6891 *cond_string = NULL;
6892 *thread = -1;
6893 while (tok && *tok)
6894 {
6895 char *end_tok;
6896 int toklen;
6897 char *cond_start = NULL;
6898 char *cond_end = NULL;
6899 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
6900 tok++;
6901
6902 end_tok = tok;
6903
6904 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
6905 end_tok++;
6906
6907 toklen = end_tok - tok;
6908
6909 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
6910 {
6911 struct expression *expr;
6912
6913 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
6914 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
6915 xfree (expr);
6916 cond_end = tok;
6917 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
6918 cond_end - cond_start);
6919 }
6920 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
6921 {
6922 char *tmptok;
6923
6924 tok = end_tok + 1;
6925 tmptok = tok;
6926 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6927 if (tok == tmptok)
6928 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
6929 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
6930 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
6931 }
6932 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
6933 {
6934 char *tmptok;
6935
6936 tok = end_tok + 1;
6937 tmptok = tok;
6938 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
6939 if (tok == tmptok)
6940 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
6941 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
6942 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
6943 }
6944 else
6945 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
6946 }
6947 }
6948
6949 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between CLI and MI
6950 functions for setting a breakpoint. This function has two major
6951 modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD
6952 parameter. If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
6953 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise, ARG is just the
6954 location of breakpoint, with condition and thread specified by the
6955 COND_STRING and THREAD parameters. Returns true if any breakpoint
6956 was created; false otherwise. */
6957
6958 int
6959 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6960 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
6961 int parse_condition_and_thread,
6962 int tempflag, int hardwareflag, int traceflag,
6963 int ignore_count,
6964 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
6965 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
6966 int from_tty,
6967 int enabled)
6968 {
6969 struct gdb_exception e;
6970 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
6971 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
6972 char *copy_arg;
6973 char *err_msg;
6974 char *addr_start = arg;
6975 char **addr_string;
6976 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6977 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
6978 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
6979 int i;
6980 int pending = 0;
6981 int not_found = 0;
6982 enum bptype type_wanted;
6983 int task = 0;
6984
6985 sals.sals = NULL;
6986 sals.nelts = 0;
6987 addr_string = NULL;
6988
6989 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
6990 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
6991 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
6992 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
6993
6994 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
6995 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
6996
6997 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
6998 switch (e.reason)
6999 {
7000 case RETURN_QUIT:
7001 throw_exception (e);
7002 case RETURN_ERROR:
7003 switch (e.error)
7004 {
7005 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
7006
7007 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
7008 error. */
7009
7010 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
7011 throw_exception (e);
7012
7013 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
7014
7015 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
7016 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
7017 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
7018 && !nquery ("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? "))
7019 return 0;
7020
7021 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
7022 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
7023 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
7024 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
7025 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
7026 addr_string = &copy_arg;
7027 sals.nelts = 1;
7028 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
7029 pending_sal.pc = 0;
7030 pending = 1;
7031 break;
7032 default:
7033 throw_exception (e);
7034 }
7035 default:
7036 if (!sals.nelts)
7037 return 0;
7038 }
7039
7040 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
7041 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7042
7043 if (!pending)
7044 {
7045 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
7046 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
7047
7048 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
7049 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
7050 }
7051
7052 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
7053 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
7054 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
7055 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
7056 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7057
7058 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
7059 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
7060 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7061 {
7062 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
7063 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
7064 }
7065
7066 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
7067 are ok for the target. */
7068 if (!pending)
7069 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals, addr_start);
7070
7071 type_wanted = (traceflag
7072 ? (hardwareflag ? bp_fast_tracepoint : bp_tracepoint)
7073 : (hardwareflag ? bp_hardware_breakpoint : bp_breakpoint));
7074
7075 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
7076 if (type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
7077 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &sals);
7078
7079 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
7080 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
7081 breakpoint. */
7082 if (!pending)
7083 {
7084 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
7085 {
7086 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
7087 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
7088 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
7089 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
7090 cond_string = NULL;
7091 thread = -1;
7092 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
7093 &thread, &task);
7094 if (cond_string)
7095 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7096 }
7097 else
7098 {
7099 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
7100 if (cond_string)
7101 {
7102 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
7103 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7104 }
7105 }
7106 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string,
7107 type_wanted, tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
7108 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
7109 enabled);
7110 }
7111 else
7112 {
7113 struct symtab_and_line sal = {0};
7114 struct breakpoint *b;
7115
7116 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
7117
7118 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
7119 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7120 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7121 b->thread = -1;
7122 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
7123 b->cond_string = NULL;
7124 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
7125 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7126 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
7127 b->ops = ops;
7128 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
7129 b->pspace = current_program_space;
7130
7131 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
7132 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
7133 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
7134 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
7135
7136 mention (b);
7137 }
7138
7139 if (sals.nelts > 1)
7140 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
7141 "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
7142 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
7143 breakpoint. */
7144 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
7145 /* But cleanup everything else. */
7146 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7147
7148 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
7149 update_global_location_list (1);
7150
7151 return 1;
7152 }
7153
7154 /* Set a breakpoint.
7155 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
7156 condition, and thread.
7157 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
7158 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
7159 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
7160
7161 static void
7162 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
7163 {
7164 int hardwareflag = flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG;
7165 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
7166
7167 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
7168 arg,
7169 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
7170 tempflag, hardwareflag, 0 /* traceflag */,
7171 0 /* Ignore count */,
7172 pending_break_support,
7173 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
7174 from_tty,
7175 1 /* enabled */);
7176 }
7177
7178
7179
7180 /* Adjust SAL to the first instruction past the function prologue.
7181 The end of the prologue is determined using the line table from
7182 the debugging information. explicit_pc and explicit_line are
7183 not modified.
7184
7185 If SAL is already past the prologue, then do nothing. */
7186
7187 static void
7188 skip_prologue_sal (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7189 {
7190 struct symbol *sym;
7191 struct symtab_and_line start_sal;
7192 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7193
7194 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7195
7196 sym = find_pc_function (sal->pc);
7197 if (sym != NULL)
7198 {
7199 start_sal = find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
7200 if (sal->pc < start_sal.pc)
7201 {
7202 start_sal.explicit_line = sal->explicit_line;
7203 start_sal.explicit_pc = sal->explicit_pc;
7204 *sal = start_sal;
7205 }
7206 }
7207
7208 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7209 }
7210
7211 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
7212
7213 void
7214 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7215 {
7216 CORE_ADDR pc;
7217
7218 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7219 {
7220 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
7221 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
7222 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
7223 sal->pc = pc;
7224
7225 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using
7226 a line number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
7227 if (sal->explicit_line)
7228 {
7229 /* Preserve the original line number. */
7230 int saved_line = sal->line;
7231 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
7232 sal->line = saved_line;
7233 }
7234 }
7235
7236 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7237 {
7238 struct blockvector *bv;
7239 struct block *b;
7240 struct symbol *sym;
7241
7242 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
7243 if (bv != NULL)
7244 {
7245 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
7246 if (sym != NULL)
7247 {
7248 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
7249 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
7250 }
7251 else
7252 {
7253 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll just
7254 have to look harder. This case can be executed if we have
7255 line numbers but no functions (as can happen in assembly
7256 source). */
7257
7258 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
7259 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7260
7261 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
7262
7263 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
7264 if (msym)
7265 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
7266
7267 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7268 }
7269 }
7270 }
7271 }
7272
7273 void
7274 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7275 {
7276 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7277 }
7278
7279 void
7280 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7281 {
7282 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
7283 }
7284
7285 static void
7286 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7287 {
7288 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
7289 }
7290
7291 static void
7292 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7293 {
7294 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
7295 }
7296
7297 static void
7298 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7299 {
7300 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
7301 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
7302 stop at <line>\n"));
7303 }
7304
7305 static void
7306 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7307 {
7308 int badInput = 0;
7309
7310 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
7311 badInput = 1;
7312 else if (*arg != '*')
7313 {
7314 char *argptr = arg;
7315 int hasColon = 0;
7316
7317 /* look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
7318 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
7319 function/method name */
7320 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7321 {
7322 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7323 argptr++;
7324 }
7325
7326 if (hasColon)
7327 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
7328 else
7329 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
7330 }
7331
7332 if (badInput)
7333 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
7334 else
7335 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7336 }
7337
7338 static void
7339 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7340 {
7341 int badInput = 0;
7342
7343 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
7344 badInput = 1;
7345 else
7346 {
7347 char *argptr = arg;
7348 int hasColon = 0;
7349
7350 /* look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
7351 it is probably a line number. */
7352 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
7353 {
7354 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
7355 argptr++;
7356 }
7357
7358 if (hasColon)
7359 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
7360 else
7361 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
7362 }
7363
7364 if (badInput)
7365 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
7366 else
7367 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7368 }
7369
7370 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
7371 hw_read: watch read,
7372 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
7373 static void
7374 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
7375 {
7376 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7377 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
7378 struct expression *exp;
7379 struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
7380 struct value *val, *mark;
7381 struct frame_info *frame;
7382 char *exp_start = NULL;
7383 char *exp_end = NULL;
7384 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
7385 int toklen;
7386 char *cond_start = NULL;
7387 char *cond_end = NULL;
7388 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
7389 enum bptype bp_type;
7390 int mem_cnt = 0;
7391 int thread = -1;
7392
7393 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
7394 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
7395 {
7396 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
7397
7398 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
7399 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
7400
7401 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last parameter.
7402 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, this should
7403 be the thread identifier. */
7404 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7405 tok--;
7406 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7407 tok--;
7408
7409 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
7410 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
7411
7412 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more parameter.
7413 If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>' parameter, we should
7414 reach a "thread" token. */
7415 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
7416 tok--;
7417
7418 end_tok = tok;
7419
7420 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
7421 tok--;
7422
7423 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
7424 calculate the length of the token. */
7425 tok++;
7426 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7427
7428 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7429 {
7430 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
7431 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
7432 only in a specific thread. */
7433 char *endp;
7434
7435 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
7436 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
7437
7438 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
7439 thread ID. */
7440 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7441 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
7442
7443 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
7444 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
7445 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
7446
7447 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
7448 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
7449 evaluate_expression() function. */
7450 *tok = '\0';
7451 }
7452 }
7453
7454 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
7455 innermost_block = NULL;
7456 exp_start = arg;
7457 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
7458 exp_end = arg;
7459 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
7460 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
7461 prettier. */
7462 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
7463 --exp_end;
7464
7465 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7466 mark = value_mark ();
7467 fetch_watchpoint_value (exp, &val, NULL, NULL);
7468 if (val != NULL)
7469 release_value (val);
7470
7471 tok = arg;
7472 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7473 tok++;
7474 end_tok = tok;
7475
7476 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7477 end_tok++;
7478
7479 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7480 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7481 {
7482 struct expression *cond;
7483
7484 innermost_block = NULL;
7485 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7486 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
7487
7488 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
7489 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
7490 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
7491
7492 xfree (cond);
7493 cond_end = tok;
7494 }
7495 if (*tok)
7496 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
7497
7498 if (accessflag == hw_read)
7499 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
7500 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
7501 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
7502 else
7503 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
7504
7505 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
7506 if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7507 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
7508 if (mem_cnt != 0)
7509 {
7510 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
7511 target_resources_ok =
7512 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
7513 other_type_used);
7514 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7515 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
7516
7517 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
7518 error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
7519 }
7520
7521 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a hardware
7522 watchpoint could not be set. */
7523 if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
7524 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
7525
7526 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
7527
7528 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
7529 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
7530 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
7531 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
7532 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
7533 {
7534 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7535 {
7536 scope_breakpoint
7537 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7538 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
7539 bp_watchpoint_scope);
7540
7541 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7542
7543 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
7544 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
7545
7546 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
7547 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
7548
7549 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
7550 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
7551 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
7552 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
7553 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7554 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
7555 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
7556 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
7557 scope_breakpoint->type);
7558 }
7559 }
7560
7561 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
7562 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
7563 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
7564 b->number = breakpoint_count;
7565 b->thread = thread;
7566 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
7567 b->exp = exp;
7568 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
7569 b->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
7570 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
7571 b->val = val;
7572 b->val_valid = 1;
7573 if (cond_start)
7574 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
7575 else
7576 b->cond_string = 0;
7577
7578 if (frame)
7579 {
7580 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
7581 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
7582 }
7583 else
7584 {
7585 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
7586 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
7587 }
7588
7589 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
7590 {
7591 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
7592 need to act on them together. */
7593 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
7594 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
7595 }
7596
7597 value_free_to_mark (mark);
7598
7599 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
7600 that should be inserted. */
7601 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
7602
7603 mention (b);
7604 update_global_location_list (1);
7605 }
7606
7607 /* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled
7608 in hardware. If the watchpoint can not be handled
7609 in hardware return zero. */
7610
7611 static int
7612 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
7613 {
7614 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
7615 struct value *head = v;
7616
7617 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
7618 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
7619 return 0;
7620
7621 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
7622 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
7623 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
7624 hardware watchpoint.
7625
7626 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
7627 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
7628 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
7629 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
7630 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
7631 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
7632 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
7633 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
7634 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
7635
7636 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
7637 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
7638 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
7639 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
7640 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
7641 {
7642 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
7643 {
7644 if (value_lazy (v))
7645 /* A lazy memory lvalue is one that GDB never needed to fetch;
7646 we either just used its address (e.g., `a' in `a.b') or
7647 we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' in `a,b'). */
7648 ;
7649 else
7650 {
7651 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
7652 it with hardware watchpoints. */
7653 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
7654
7655 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
7656 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
7657 middle of some value chain. */
7658 if (v == head
7659 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7660 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
7661 {
7662 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
7663 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
7664
7665 if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
7666 return 0;
7667 else
7668 found_memory_cnt++;
7669 }
7670 }
7671 }
7672 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
7673 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
7674 return 0; /* ??? What does this represent? */
7675 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
7676 return 0; /* cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint */
7677 }
7678
7679 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
7680 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
7681 return found_memory_cnt;
7682 }
7683
7684 void
7685 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7686 {
7687 watch_command (arg, from_tty);
7688 }
7689
7690 static void
7691 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7692 {
7693 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
7694 }
7695
7696 void
7697 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7698 {
7699 rwatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7700 }
7701
7702 static void
7703 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7704 {
7705 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
7706 }
7707
7708 void
7709 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty)
7710 {
7711 awatch_command (arg, from_tty);
7712 }
7713
7714 static void
7715 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7716 {
7717 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
7718 }
7719 \f
7720
7721 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
7722 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
7723
7724 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
7725 {
7726 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7727 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
7728 };
7729
7730 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
7731 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
7732 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
7733 command. */
7734 static void
7735 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
7736 {
7737 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
7738
7739 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
7740 if (a->breakpoint2)
7741 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
7742 }
7743
7744 void
7745 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
7746 {
7747 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7748 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7749 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
7750 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
7751 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
7752 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7753
7754 clear_proceed_status ();
7755
7756 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
7757 this function */
7758
7759 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7760 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7761 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7762 else
7763 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
7764 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
7765
7766 if (sals.nelts != 1)
7767 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
7768
7769 sal = sals.sals[0];
7770 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed */
7771
7772 if (*arg)
7773 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7774
7775 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
7776
7777 if (anywhere)
7778 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
7779 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
7780 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7781 null_frame_id, bp_until);
7782 else
7783 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only
7784 at the very same frame. */
7785 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
7786 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
7787 bp_until);
7788
7789 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
7790
7791 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
7792 one. */
7793
7794 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
7795 {
7796 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
7797 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
7798 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
7799 sal,
7800 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
7801 bp_until);
7802 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
7803 }
7804
7805 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
7806
7807 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has actually
7808 managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to be
7809 deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already stopped and
7810 delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
7811
7812 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
7813 {
7814 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
7815 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
7816
7817 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
7818 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
7819
7820 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
7821 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
7822 until_break_command_continuation, args,
7823 xfree);
7824 }
7825 else
7826 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7827 }
7828
7829 static void
7830 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
7831 {
7832 if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
7833 return;
7834 while (isspace (**s))
7835 *s += 1;
7836 }
7837
7838 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
7839 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
7840
7841 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
7842 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
7843 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
7844 if clause in the arg string. */
7845
7846 static char *
7847 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
7848 {
7849 char *cond_string;
7850
7851 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
7852 return NULL;
7853
7854 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
7855 (*arg) += 2;
7856
7857 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
7858 condition string. */
7859 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
7860 cond_string = *arg;
7861
7862 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg string. */
7863 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
7864
7865 return cond_string;
7866 }
7867
7868 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
7869 process start/exit, etc. */
7870
7871 typedef enum
7872 {
7873 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
7874 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
7875 }
7876 catch_fork_kind;
7877
7878 static void
7879 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7880 {
7881 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7882 char *cond_string = NULL;
7883 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
7884 int tempflag;
7885
7886 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
7887 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
7888 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
7889
7890 if (!arg)
7891 arg = "";
7892 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7893
7894 /* The allowed syntax is:
7895 catch [v]fork
7896 catch [v]fork if <cond>
7897
7898 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7899 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7900
7901 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7902 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7903
7904 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
7905 and enable reporting of such events. */
7906 switch (fork_kind)
7907 {
7908 case catch_fork_temporary:
7909 case catch_fork_permanent:
7910 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7911 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
7912 break;
7913 case catch_vfork_temporary:
7914 case catch_vfork_permanent:
7915 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7916 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
7917 break;
7918 default:
7919 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
7920 break;
7921 }
7922 }
7923
7924 static void
7925 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
7926 {
7927 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
7928 int tempflag;
7929 char *cond_string = NULL;
7930
7931 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
7932
7933 if (!arg)
7934 arg = "";
7935 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
7936
7937 /* The allowed syntax is:
7938 catch exec
7939 catch exec if <cond>
7940
7941 First, check if there's an if clause. */
7942 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
7943
7944 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
7945 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7946
7947 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
7948 and enable reporting of such events. */
7949 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
7950 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
7951 }
7952
7953 static enum print_stop_action
7954 print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
7955 {
7956 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
7957
7958 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7959
7960 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
7961 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
7962 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
7963 b->loc->address,
7964 b->number, 1);
7965 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
7966 ui_out_text (uiout,
7967 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
7968 : "Catchpoint ");
7969 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7970 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7971 ui_out_text (uiout,
7972 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
7973 : " (exception caught), ");
7974 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7975 {
7976 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7977 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
7978 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7979 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7980 }
7981 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7982 }
7983
7984 static void
7985 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7986 {
7987 struct value_print_options opts;
7988 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7989 if (opts.addressprint)
7990 {
7991 annotate_field (4);
7992 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
7993 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
7994 else
7995 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
7996 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
7997 }
7998 annotate_field (5);
7999 if (b->loc)
8000 *last_loc = b->loc;
8001 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
8002 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
8003 else
8004 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
8005 }
8006
8007 static void
8008 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8009 {
8010 int bp_temp;
8011 int bp_throw;
8012
8013 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
8014 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
8015 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
8016 : _("Catchpoint "));
8017 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8018 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
8019 : _(" (catch)"));
8020 }
8021
8022 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
8023 NULL, /* insert */
8024 NULL, /* remove */
8025 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
8026 print_exception_catchpoint,
8027 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
8028 print_mention_exception_catchpoint
8029 };
8030
8031 static int
8032 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8033 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
8034 {
8035 char *trigger_func_name;
8036
8037 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
8038 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
8039 else
8040 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
8041
8042 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
8043 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
8044 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
8045 tempflag, 0, 0,
8046 0,
8047 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
8048 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
8049 1 /* enabled */);
8050
8051 return 1;
8052 }
8053
8054 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands */
8055
8056 static void
8057 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
8058 int tempflag, int from_tty)
8059 {
8060 char *cond_string = NULL;
8061 struct symtab_and_line *sal = NULL;
8062
8063 if (!arg)
8064 arg = "";
8065 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8066
8067 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
8068
8069 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
8070 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8071
8072 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
8073 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
8074 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
8075
8076 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
8077 return;
8078
8079 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
8080 }
8081
8082 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
8083
8084 static void
8085 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8086 {
8087 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8088 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
8089 }
8090
8091 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
8092
8093 static void
8094 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8095 {
8096 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8097 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
8098 }
8099
8100 /* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
8101
8102 static void
8103 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8104 struct symtab_and_line sal,
8105 char *addr_string,
8106 char *exp_string,
8107 char *cond_string,
8108 struct expression *cond,
8109 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8110 int tempflag,
8111 int from_tty)
8112 {
8113 struct breakpoint *b;
8114
8115 if (from_tty)
8116 {
8117 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8118 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8119 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8120
8121 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8122 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
8123 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
8124 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
8125 used for different exception names will use the same address.
8126 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
8127 unproductive. Besides. the warning phrasing is also a bit
8128 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
8129 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
8130 enough for now, though. */
8131 }
8132
8133 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
8134 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
8135
8136 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8137 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8138 b->number = breakpoint_count;
8139 b->ignore_count = 0;
8140 b->loc->cond = cond;
8141 b->addr_string = addr_string;
8142 b->language = language_ada;
8143 b->cond_string = cond_string;
8144 b->exp_string = exp_string;
8145 b->thread = -1;
8146 b->ops = ops;
8147
8148 mention (b);
8149 update_global_location_list (1);
8150 }
8151
8152 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
8153
8154 static void
8155 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
8156 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8157 {
8158 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8159 int tempflag;
8160 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8161 enum bptype type;
8162 char *addr_string = NULL;
8163 char *exp_string = NULL;
8164 char *cond_string = NULL;
8165 struct expression *cond = NULL;
8166 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8167
8168 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8169
8170 if (!arg)
8171 arg = "";
8172 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
8173 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
8174 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
8175 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
8176 from_tty);
8177 }
8178
8179 /* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
8180 static void
8181 clean_up_filters (void *arg)
8182 {
8183 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
8184 VEC_free (int, iter);
8185 }
8186
8187 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
8188 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
8189 static VEC(int) *
8190 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
8191 {
8192 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
8193 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
8194
8195 while (*arg != '\0')
8196 {
8197 int i, syscall_number;
8198 char *endptr;
8199 char cur_name[128];
8200 struct syscall s;
8201
8202 /* Skip whitespace. */
8203 while (isspace (*arg))
8204 arg++;
8205
8206 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
8207 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
8208 cur_name[i] = '\0';
8209 arg += i;
8210
8211 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
8212 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
8213 if (*endptr == '\0')
8214 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
8215 else
8216 {
8217 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
8218 to a number. */
8219 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
8220
8221 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
8222 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning, because
8223 GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no syscall number to
8224 be caught. */
8225 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
8226 }
8227
8228 /* Ok, it's valid. */
8229 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
8230 }
8231
8232 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8233 return result;
8234 }
8235
8236 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
8237
8238 static void
8239 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8240 {
8241 int tempflag;
8242 VEC(int) *filter;
8243 struct syscall s;
8244 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8245
8246 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
8247 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
8248 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
8249 this architeture yet."));
8250
8251 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8252
8253 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8254
8255 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
8256 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
8257 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
8258 for his/her architecture. */
8259 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
8260
8261 /* The allowed syntax is:
8262 catch syscall
8263 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
8264
8265 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
8266
8267 if (arg != NULL)
8268 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
8269 else
8270 filter = NULL;
8271
8272 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
8273 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8274 }
8275
8276 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
8277
8278 static void
8279 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
8280 {
8281 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8282 int tempflag;
8283 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8284 char *addr_string = NULL;
8285 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
8286
8287 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8288
8289 if (!arg)
8290 arg = "";
8291 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
8292 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
8293 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
8294 }
8295
8296 static void
8297 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8298 {
8299 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8300 }
8301 \f
8302
8303 static void
8304 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8305 {
8306 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
8307 }
8308
8309 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
8310
8311 static void
8312 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8313 {
8314 struct breakpoint *b;
8315 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
8316 int ix;
8317 int default_match;
8318 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8319 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8320 int i;
8321
8322 if (arg)
8323 {
8324 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
8325 default_match = 0;
8326 }
8327 else
8328 {
8329 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
8330 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
8331 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
8332 init_sal (&sal); /* initialize to zeroes */
8333 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
8334 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
8335 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
8336 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
8337 if (sal.symtab == 0)
8338 error (_("No source file specified."));
8339
8340 sals.sals[0] = sal;
8341 sals.nelts = 1;
8342
8343 default_match = 1;
8344 }
8345
8346 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not
8347 as bad as it seems, because all existing breakpoints
8348 typically have both file/line and pc set. So, if
8349 clear is given file/line, we can match this to existing
8350 breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
8351
8352 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
8353 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
8354 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
8355 due to optimization, all in one block.
8356 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
8357 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
8358 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
8359 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
8360 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
8361 to support that. */
8362
8363 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond
8364 to it. Do it in two passes, solely to preserve the current
8365 behavior that from_tty is forced true if we delete more than
8366 one breakpoint. */
8367
8368 found = NULL;
8369 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
8370 {
8371 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
8372 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
8373 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
8374 or at default pc.
8375
8376 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
8377
8378 0 1 pc
8379 1 1 pc _and_ line
8380 0 0 line
8381 1 0 <can't happen> */
8382
8383 sal = sals.sals[i];
8384
8385 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to
8386 'found'. */
8387 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8388 {
8389 int match = 0;
8390 /* Are we going to delete b? */
8391 if (b->type != bp_none
8392 && b->type != bp_watchpoint
8393 && b->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
8394 && b->type != bp_read_watchpoint
8395 && b->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
8396 {
8397 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
8398 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
8399 {
8400 int pc_match = sal.pc
8401 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
8402 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
8403 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
8404 || loc->section == sal.section);
8405 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
8406 && b->source_file != NULL
8407 && sal.symtab != NULL
8408 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
8409 && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
8410 && b->line_number == sal.line);
8411 if (pc_match || line_match)
8412 {
8413 match = 1;
8414 break;
8415 }
8416 }
8417 }
8418
8419 if (match)
8420 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
8421 }
8422 }
8423 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
8424 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
8425 {
8426 if (arg)
8427 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
8428 else
8429 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
8430 }
8431
8432 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
8433 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one */
8434 if (from_tty)
8435 {
8436 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
8437 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
8438 else
8439 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
8440 }
8441 breakpoints_changed ();
8442
8443 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
8444 {
8445 if (from_tty)
8446 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
8447 delete_breakpoint (b);
8448 }
8449 if (from_tty)
8450 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
8451 }
8452 \f
8453 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
8454 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
8455 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
8456
8457 void
8458 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
8459 {
8460 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
8461
8462 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
8463 if (bs->breakpoint_at
8464 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner
8465 && bs->breakpoint_at->owner->disposition == disp_del
8466 && bs->stop)
8467 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at->owner);
8468
8469 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
8470 {
8471 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
8472 delete_breakpoint (b);
8473 }
8474 }
8475
8476 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to qsort.
8477 Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what does
8478 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER), secondarily by ordering
8479 first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and terciarily just ensuring the array
8480 is sorted stable way despite qsort being an instable algorithm. */
8481
8482 static int
8483 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
8484 {
8485 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
8486 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
8487 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8488 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
8489
8490 if (a->address != b->address)
8491 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
8492
8493 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
8494 if (a_perm != b_perm)
8495 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
8496
8497 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of the same
8498 breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
8499
8500 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
8501 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
8502 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
8503
8504 return (a > b) - (a < b);
8505 }
8506
8507 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
8508 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current content of
8509 the bp_location array. */
8510
8511 static void
8512 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
8513 {
8514 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
8515
8516 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
8517 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
8518
8519 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
8520 {
8521 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
8522
8523 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
8524 continue;
8525
8526 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
8527 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
8528
8529 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
8530 addr = bl->address - start;
8531 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
8532 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
8533
8534 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
8535
8536 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
8537 addr = end - bl->address;
8538 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
8539 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
8540 }
8541 }
8542
8543 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
8544 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
8545 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
8546 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
8547 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
8548 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
8549 returns true on them.
8550
8551 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
8552 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
8553 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
8554 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
8555 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
8556 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
8557
8558 static void
8559 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
8560 {
8561 struct breakpoint *b;
8562 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
8563 struct cleanup *cleanups;
8564
8565 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
8566 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
8567 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
8568 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
8569 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
8570 once. */
8571 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
8572 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
8573 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
8574 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
8575
8576 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly built
8577 bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
8578 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
8579 unsigned old_location_count;
8580
8581 old_location = bp_location;
8582 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
8583 bp_location = NULL;
8584 bp_location_count = 0;
8585 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
8586
8587 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8588 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8589 bp_location_count++;
8590
8591 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
8592 locp = bp_location;
8593 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8594 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
8595 *locp++ = loc;
8596 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
8597 bp_location_compare);
8598
8599 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
8600
8601 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the new
8602 list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not necessary that
8603 those locations should be removed from inferior -- if there's another
8604 location at the same address (previously marked as duplicate),
8605 we don't need to remove/insert the location.
8606
8607 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current and
8608 former bp_location array state respectively. */
8609
8610 locp = bp_location;
8611 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
8612 old_locp++)
8613 {
8614 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
8615 struct bp_location **loc2p;
8616
8617 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If not, we
8618 have to free it. */
8619 int found_object = 0;
8620 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
8621 int keep_in_target = 0;
8622 int removed = 0;
8623
8624 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. Stop either
8625 at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
8626 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
8627 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
8628 locp++;
8629
8630 for (loc2p = locp;
8631 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8632 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8633 loc2p++)
8634 {
8635 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
8636 {
8637 found_object = 1;
8638 break;
8639 }
8640 }
8641
8642 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if there's
8643 maybe a new location at the same address. If so, mark that one
8644 inserted, and don't remove this one. This is needed so that we
8645 don't have a time window where a breakpoint at certain location is not
8646 inserted. */
8647
8648 if (old_loc->inserted)
8649 {
8650 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove it. */
8651
8652 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
8653 {
8654 /* The location is still present in the location list, and still
8655 should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
8656 keep_in_target = 1;
8657 }
8658 else
8659 {
8660 /* The location is either no longer present, or got disabled.
8661 See if there's another location at the same address, in which
8662 case we don't need to remove this one from the target. */
8663
8664 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
8665 {
8666 for (loc2p = locp;
8667 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
8668 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
8669 loc2p++)
8670 {
8671 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
8672
8673 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
8674 {
8675 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
8676 Duplicates check below will fix up this later. */
8677 loc2->duplicate = 0;
8678
8679 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
8680 access watchpoints, if the former are not
8681 supported, but the latter are. */
8682 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8683 {
8684 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
8685 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
8686 }
8687
8688 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
8689 {
8690 loc2->inserted = 1;
8691 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
8692 keep_in_target = 1;
8693 break;
8694 }
8695 }
8696 }
8697 }
8698 }
8699
8700 if (!keep_in_target)
8701 {
8702 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
8703 {
8704 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep this
8705 location on the global list, and try to remove it next
8706 time, but there's no particular reason why we will
8707 succeed next time.
8708
8709 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still valid,
8710 as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint only
8711 after calling us. */
8712 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
8713 old_loc->owner->number);
8714 }
8715 removed = 1;
8716 }
8717 }
8718
8719 if (!found_object)
8720 {
8721 if (removed && non_stop
8722 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
8723 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
8724 {
8725 /* This location was removed from the target. In
8726 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
8727 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
8728 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
8729 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
8730 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
8731 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
8732 after we see some number of events. The theory here
8733 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
8734 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
8735 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
8736 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
8737 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
8738 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
8739 SIGTRAP.
8740
8741 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
8742 decr_pc_after_break targets.
8743
8744 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
8745 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
8746 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
8747 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
8748 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
8749 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
8750 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SEGSEGV, or worse, get silently
8751 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
8752 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
8753 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
8754 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
8755 targets that do not support new thread events, like
8756 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
8757 thread_count.
8758
8759 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
8760 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
8761 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
8762 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
8763
8764 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
8765 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
8766 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
8767 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
8768 traps we can no longer explain. */
8769
8770 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
8771 old_loc->owner = NULL;
8772
8773 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
8774 }
8775 else
8776 free_bp_location (old_loc);
8777 }
8778 }
8779
8780 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
8781 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
8782 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
8783 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
8784 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
8785 are sorted first for the same address.
8786
8787 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
8788 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
8789
8790 bp_loc_first = NULL;
8791 wp_loc_first = NULL;
8792 awp_loc_first = NULL;
8793 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
8794 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
8795 {
8796 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
8797 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
8798
8799 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
8800 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
8801 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
8802 || !loc->enabled
8803 || loc->shlib_disabled
8804 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
8805 || tracepoint_type (b))
8806 continue;
8807
8808 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
8809 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
8810 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8811 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
8812 "actually inserted"));
8813
8814 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8815 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
8816 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
8817 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
8818 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
8819 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
8820 else
8821 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
8822
8823 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
8824 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
8825 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
8826 {
8827 *loc_first_p = loc;
8828 loc->duplicate = 0;
8829 continue;
8830 }
8831
8832 loc->duplicate = 1;
8833
8834 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
8835 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
8836 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8837 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
8838 "a permanent breakpoint"));
8839 }
8840
8841 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
8842 && (have_live_inferiors ()
8843 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
8844 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
8845
8846 do_cleanups (cleanups);
8847 }
8848
8849 void
8850 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
8851 {
8852 struct bp_location *loc;
8853 int ix;
8854
8855 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
8856 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
8857 {
8858 free_bp_location (loc);
8859 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
8860 --ix;
8861 }
8862 }
8863
8864 static void
8865 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
8866 {
8867 struct gdb_exception e;
8868 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
8869 update_global_location_list (inserting);
8870 }
8871
8872 /* Clear BPT from a BPS. */
8873 static void
8874 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
8875 {
8876 bpstat bs;
8877 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
8878 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->owner == bpt)
8879 {
8880 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
8881 bs->old_val = NULL;
8882 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
8883 }
8884 }
8885
8886 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
8887 static int
8888 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
8889 {
8890 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
8891 bpstat_remove_breakpoint (th->stop_bpstat, bpt);
8892 return 0;
8893 }
8894
8895 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
8896 structures. */
8897
8898 void
8899 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
8900 {
8901 struct breakpoint *b;
8902 struct bp_location *loc, *next;
8903
8904 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
8905
8906 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because multiple
8907 lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are especial culprits.
8908
8909 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When the
8910 scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of scope, and
8911 delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the scope bp is marked
8912 "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. That bpstat is then
8913 checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are deleted.
8914
8915 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in bp's,
8916 and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing bpstat's, and
8917 teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's storage when no more
8918 references were extent. A cheaper bandaid was chosen. */
8919 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
8920 return;
8921
8922 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting of
8923 breakpoints gets resolved. */
8924 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != NULL)
8925 {
8926 gdb_assert (bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == bpt);
8927 bpt->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
8928 bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
8929 bpt->related_breakpoint = NULL;
8930 }
8931
8932 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
8933
8934 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
8935 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
8936
8937 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8938 if (b->next == bpt)
8939 {
8940 b->next = bpt->next;
8941 break;
8942 }
8943
8944 free_command_lines (&bpt->commands);
8945 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
8946 xfree (bpt->cond_exp);
8947 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
8948 xfree (bpt->exp);
8949 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
8950 value_free (bpt->val);
8951 xfree (bpt->source_file);
8952 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
8953 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
8954
8955 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at it after it's been freed. */
8956 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's?
8957 We just check stop_bpstat for now. Note that we cannot just
8958 remove bpstats pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list
8959 entirely, as breakpoint commands are associated with the bpstat;
8960 if we remove it here, then the later call to
8961 bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat);
8962 in event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints
8963 with commands won't work. */
8964
8965 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
8966
8967 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint
8968 list, update the global location list. This
8969 will remove locations that used to belong to
8970 this breakpoint. Do this before freeing
8971 the breakpoint itself, since remove_breakpoint
8972 looks at location's owner. It might be better
8973 design to have location completely self-contained,
8974 but it's not the case now. */
8975 update_global_location_list (0);
8976
8977
8978 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this same
8979 bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
8980 bpt->type = bp_none;
8981
8982 xfree (bpt);
8983 }
8984
8985 static void
8986 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
8987 {
8988 delete_breakpoint (b);
8989 }
8990
8991 struct cleanup *
8992 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8993 {
8994 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
8995 }
8996
8997 void
8998 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8999 {
9000 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9001
9002 dont_repeat ();
9003
9004 if (arg == 0)
9005 {
9006 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
9007
9008 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
9009 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
9010 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
9011 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9012 {
9013 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
9014 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
9015 && b->type != bp_jit_event
9016 && b->type != bp_thread_event
9017 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
9018 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
9019 && b->number >= 0)
9020 {
9021 breaks_to_delete = 1;
9022 break;
9023 }
9024 }
9025
9026 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
9027 if (!from_tty
9028 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
9029 {
9030 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9031 {
9032 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
9033 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
9034 && b->type != bp_thread_event
9035 && b->type != bp_jit_event
9036 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
9037 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
9038 && b->number >= 0)
9039 delete_breakpoint (b);
9040 }
9041 }
9042 }
9043 else
9044 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
9045 }
9046
9047 static int
9048 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
9049 {
9050 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
9051 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
9052 return 0;
9053 return 1;
9054 }
9055
9056 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
9057 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
9058 Null names are ignored. */
9059
9060 static int
9061 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
9062 {
9063 struct bp_location *l;
9064 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
9065 (int (*) (const void *, const void *)) streq,
9066 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
9067
9068 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
9069 {
9070 const char **slot;
9071 const char *name = l->function_name;
9072
9073 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
9074 if (name == NULL)
9075 continue;
9076
9077 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
9078 INSERT);
9079 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never returns
9080 NULL. */
9081 if (*slot != NULL)
9082 {
9083 htab_delete (htab);
9084 return 1;
9085 }
9086 *slot = name;
9087 }
9088
9089 htab_delete (htab);
9090 return 0;
9091 }
9092
9093 static void
9094 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
9095 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
9096 {
9097 int i;
9098 char *s;
9099 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
9100
9101 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations
9102 are pending, don't do anything. This optimizes
9103 the common case where all locations are in the same
9104 shared library, that was unloaded. We'd like to
9105 retain the location, so that when the library
9106 is loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled
9107 status of the individual locations. */
9108 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
9109 return;
9110
9111 b->loc = NULL;
9112
9113 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
9114 {
9115 struct bp_location *new_loc =
9116 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
9117
9118 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
9119 old symtab. */
9120 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
9121 {
9122 struct gdb_exception e;
9123
9124 s = b->cond_string;
9125 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9126 {
9127 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
9128 0);
9129 }
9130 if (e.reason < 0)
9131 {
9132 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
9133 b->number, e.message);
9134 new_loc->enabled = 0;
9135 }
9136 }
9137
9138 if (b->source_file != NULL)
9139 xfree (b->source_file);
9140 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
9141 b->source_file = NULL;
9142 else
9143 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
9144
9145 if (b->line_number == 0)
9146 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
9147 }
9148
9149 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
9150 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9151 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
9152
9153 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing breakpoints. */
9154 {
9155 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
9156 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
9157 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
9158 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
9159 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
9160 often enough until a better solution is found. */
9161 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
9162
9163 for (; e; e = e->next)
9164 {
9165 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
9166 {
9167 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
9168 if (have_ambiguous_names)
9169 {
9170 for (; l; l = l->next)
9171 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
9172 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
9173 {
9174 l->enabled = 0;
9175 break;
9176 }
9177 }
9178 else
9179 {
9180 for (; l; l = l->next)
9181 if (l->function_name
9182 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
9183 {
9184 l->enabled = 0;
9185 break;
9186 }
9187 }
9188 }
9189 }
9190 }
9191
9192 update_global_location_list (1);
9193 }
9194
9195
9196 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
9197 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
9198 Unused in this case. */
9199
9200 static int
9201 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
9202 {
9203 /* get past catch_errs */
9204 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
9205 struct value *mark;
9206 int i;
9207 int not_found = 0;
9208 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
9209 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
9210 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
9211 char *s;
9212 enum enable_state save_enable;
9213 struct gdb_exception e;
9214 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
9215
9216 switch (b->type)
9217 {
9218 case bp_none:
9219 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9220 b->number);
9221 return 0;
9222 case bp_breakpoint:
9223 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9224 case bp_tracepoint:
9225 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9226 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
9227 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
9228 return 0;
9229
9230 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
9231 {
9232 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
9233 delete_breakpoint (b);
9234 return 0;
9235 }
9236
9237 set_language (b->language);
9238 input_radix = b->input_radix;
9239 s = b->addr_string;
9240
9241 save_current_space_and_thread ();
9242 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
9243
9244 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9245 {
9246 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
9247 not_found_ptr);
9248 }
9249 if (e.reason < 0)
9250 {
9251 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
9252 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing
9253 will fail until the right shared library is loaded.
9254 User has already told to create pending breakpoints and
9255 don't need extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
9256 state, then user already saw the message about that breakpoint
9257 being disabled, and don't want to see more errors. */
9258 if (not_found
9259 && (b->condition_not_parsed
9260 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
9261 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
9262 not_found_and_ok = 1;
9263
9264 if (!not_found_and_ok)
9265 {
9266 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
9267 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
9268 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
9269 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
9270 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
9271 which approach is better. */
9272 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9273 throw_exception (e);
9274 }
9275 }
9276
9277 if (!not_found)
9278 {
9279 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
9280
9281 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
9282 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
9283 {
9284 char *cond_string = 0;
9285 int thread = -1;
9286 int task = 0;
9287
9288 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
9289 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
9290 if (cond_string)
9291 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9292 b->thread = thread;
9293 b->task = task;
9294 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
9295 }
9296
9297 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
9298 }
9299
9300 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9301 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
9302 break;
9303
9304 case bp_watchpoint:
9305 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9306 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9307 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9308 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global variables,
9309 or it can be on local variables.
9310
9311 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even persist
9312 across program restarts. Since they can use variables from shared
9313 libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries are loaded
9314 and unloaded.
9315
9316 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
9317 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local and
9318 a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, but
9319 unloading of a shared library will make the expression invalid.
9320 This is not a very common use case, but we still re-evaluate
9321 expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
9322
9323 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
9324 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
9325 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
9326 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
9327
9328 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
9329 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
9330
9331 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
9332 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
9333 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
9334 break;
9335 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
9336 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
9337 loaded. */
9338 case bp_catchpoint:
9339 break;
9340
9341 default:
9342 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
9343 /* fall through */
9344 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
9345 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
9346 case bp_overlay_event:
9347 case bp_longjmp_master:
9348 delete_breakpoint (b);
9349 break;
9350
9351 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
9352 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
9353 case bp_shlib_event:
9354
9355 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
9356 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
9357 case bp_thread_event:
9358
9359 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
9360 over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the breakpoints.
9361 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
9362 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
9363 case bp_until:
9364 case bp_finish:
9365 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
9366 case bp_call_dummy:
9367 case bp_step_resume:
9368 case bp_longjmp:
9369 case bp_longjmp_resume:
9370 case bp_jit_event:
9371 break;
9372 }
9373
9374 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9375 return 0;
9376 }
9377
9378 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
9379 void
9380 breakpoint_re_set (void)
9381 {
9382 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
9383 enum language save_language;
9384 int save_input_radix;
9385 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9386
9387 save_language = current_language->la_language;
9388 save_input_radix = input_radix;
9389 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
9390
9391 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
9392 {
9393 /* Format possible error msg */
9394 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
9395 b->number);
9396 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
9397 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
9398 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9399 }
9400 set_language (save_language);
9401 input_radix = save_input_radix;
9402
9403 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
9404
9405 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9406
9407 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
9408 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
9409 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
9410 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
9411 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
9412 }
9413 \f
9414 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
9415
9416 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
9417 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
9418 void
9419 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
9420 {
9421 if (b->thread != -1)
9422 {
9423 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9424 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9425
9426 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
9427 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
9428 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
9429 as well. */
9430 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
9431 }
9432 }
9433
9434 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9435 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9436 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9437
9438 void
9439 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
9440 {
9441 struct breakpoint *b;
9442
9443 if (count < 0)
9444 count = 0;
9445
9446 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9447 if (b->number == bptnum)
9448 {
9449 b->ignore_count = count;
9450 if (from_tty)
9451 {
9452 if (count == 0)
9453 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
9454 bptnum);
9455 else if (count == 1)
9456 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
9457 bptnum);
9458 else
9459 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
9460 count, bptnum);
9461 }
9462 breakpoints_changed ();
9463 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
9464 return;
9465 }
9466
9467 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
9468 }
9469
9470 void
9471 make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
9472 {
9473 /* Silence the breakpoint. */
9474 b->silent = 1;
9475 }
9476
9477 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
9478
9479 static void
9480 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9481 {
9482 char *p = args;
9483 int num;
9484
9485 if (p == 0)
9486 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
9487
9488 num = get_number (&p);
9489 if (num == 0)
9490 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
9491 if (*p == 0)
9492 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
9493
9494 set_ignore_count (num,
9495 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
9496 from_tty);
9497 if (from_tty)
9498 printf_filtered ("\n");
9499 }
9500 \f
9501 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
9502 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
9503
9504 static void
9505 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *))
9506 {
9507 char *p = args;
9508 char *p1;
9509 int num;
9510 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
9511 int match;
9512
9513 if (p == 0)
9514 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
9515
9516 while (*p)
9517 {
9518 match = 0;
9519 p1 = p;
9520
9521 num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9522 if (num == 0)
9523 {
9524 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
9525 }
9526 else
9527 {
9528 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
9529 if (b->number == num)
9530 {
9531 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
9532 match = 1;
9533 function (b);
9534 if (related_breakpoint)
9535 function (related_breakpoint);
9536 break;
9537 }
9538 if (match == 0)
9539 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
9540 }
9541 p = p1;
9542 }
9543 }
9544
9545 static struct bp_location *
9546 find_location_by_number (char *number)
9547 {
9548 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
9549 char *p1;
9550 int bp_num;
9551 int loc_num;
9552 struct breakpoint *b;
9553 struct bp_location *loc;
9554
9555 *dot = '\0';
9556
9557 p1 = number;
9558 bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9559 if (bp_num == 0)
9560 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9561
9562 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9563 if (b->number == bp_num)
9564 {
9565 break;
9566 }
9567
9568 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
9569 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
9570
9571 p1 = dot+1;
9572 loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
9573 if (loc_num == 0)
9574 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
9575
9576 --loc_num;
9577 loc = b->loc;
9578 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
9579 ;
9580 if (!loc)
9581 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
9582
9583 return loc;
9584 }
9585
9586
9587 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
9588 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
9589 which ends with a period (no newline). */
9590
9591 void
9592 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9593 {
9594 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
9595 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
9596 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
9597 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
9598 return;
9599
9600 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
9601 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
9602 return;
9603
9604 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
9605
9606 update_global_location_list (0);
9607
9608 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9609 }
9610
9611 static void
9612 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9613 {
9614 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9615 if (args == 0)
9616 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9617 switch (bpt->type)
9618 {
9619 case bp_none:
9620 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9621 bpt->number);
9622 continue;
9623 case bp_breakpoint:
9624 case bp_tracepoint:
9625 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9626 case bp_catchpoint:
9627 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9628 case bp_watchpoint:
9629 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9630 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9631 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9632 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
9633 default:
9634 continue;
9635 }
9636 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9637 {
9638 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9639 if (loc)
9640 loc->enabled = 0;
9641 update_global_location_list (0);
9642 }
9643 else
9644 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, disable_breakpoint);
9645 }
9646
9647 static void
9648 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
9649 {
9650 int target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
9651 struct value *mark;
9652
9653 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9654 {
9655 int i;
9656 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9657 target_resources_ok =
9658 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9659 i + 1, 0);
9660 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9661 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9662 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9663 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9664 }
9665
9666 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint
9667 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9668 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
9669 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9670 {
9671 struct gdb_exception e;
9672
9673 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9674 {
9675 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
9676 }
9677 if (e.reason < 0)
9678 {
9679 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
9680 bpt->number);
9681 return;
9682 }
9683 }
9684
9685 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9686 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9687 bpt->disposition = disposition;
9688 update_global_location_list (1);
9689 breakpoints_changed ();
9690
9691 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
9692 }
9693
9694
9695 void
9696 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9697 {
9698 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
9699 }
9700
9701 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
9702 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
9703 in stopping the inferior. */
9704
9705 static void
9706 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9707 {
9708 struct breakpoint *bpt;
9709 if (args == 0)
9710 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
9711 switch (bpt->type)
9712 {
9713 case bp_none:
9714 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
9715 bpt->number);
9716 continue;
9717 case bp_breakpoint:
9718 case bp_tracepoint:
9719 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
9720 case bp_catchpoint:
9721 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
9722 case bp_watchpoint:
9723 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
9724 case bp_read_watchpoint:
9725 case bp_access_watchpoint:
9726 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
9727 default:
9728 continue;
9729 }
9730 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
9731 {
9732 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
9733 if (loc)
9734 loc->enabled = 1;
9735 update_global_location_list (1);
9736 }
9737 else
9738 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_breakpoint);
9739 }
9740
9741 static void
9742 enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9743 {
9744 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
9745 }
9746
9747 static void
9748 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9749 {
9750 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint);
9751 }
9752
9753 static void
9754 enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9755 {
9756 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
9757 }
9758
9759 static void
9760 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
9761 {
9762 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint);
9763 }
9764 \f
9765 static void
9766 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9767 {
9768 }
9769
9770 static void
9771 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
9772 {
9773 }
9774
9775 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
9776 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
9777 GDB itself. */
9778
9779 static void
9780 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
9781 const bfd_byte *data)
9782 {
9783 struct breakpoint *bp;
9784
9785 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9786 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
9787 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
9788 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
9789 {
9790 struct bp_location *loc;
9791
9792 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
9793 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
9794 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
9795 && addr + len > loc->address)
9796 {
9797 value_free (bp->val);
9798 bp->val = NULL;
9799 bp->val_valid = 0;
9800 }
9801 }
9802 }
9803
9804 /* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
9805
9806 struct symtabs_and_lines
9807 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
9808 {
9809 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9810 if (string == 0)
9811 error (_("Empty line specification."));
9812 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
9813 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9814 default_breakpoint_symtab,
9815 default_breakpoint_line,
9816 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9817 else
9818 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
9819 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
9820 if (*string)
9821 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
9822 return sals;
9823 }
9824
9825 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
9826 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
9827 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
9828 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
9829 someday. */
9830
9831 void *
9832 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9833 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9834 {
9835 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
9836
9837 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
9838
9839 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
9840 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
9841
9842 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
9843 {
9844 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
9845 xfree (bp_tgt);
9846 return NULL;
9847 }
9848
9849 return bp_tgt;
9850 }
9851
9852 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
9853
9854 int
9855 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
9856 {
9857 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
9858 int ret;
9859
9860 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
9861 xfree (bp_tgt);
9862
9863 return ret;
9864 }
9865
9866 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single stepping. */
9867
9868 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
9869 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
9870
9871 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
9872
9873 void
9874 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9875 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR next_pc)
9876 {
9877 void **bpt_p;
9878
9879 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
9880 {
9881 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
9882 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
9883 }
9884 else
9885 {
9886 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
9887 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
9888 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
9889 }
9890
9891 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would be
9892 to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on the
9893 breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint. We could
9894 adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing this requires
9895 corresponding changes elsewhere where single step breakpoints are
9896 handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
9897
9898 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
9899 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
9900 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
9901 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
9902 }
9903
9904 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
9905
9906 void
9907 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
9908 {
9909 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
9910
9911 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
9912 call. */
9913 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
9914 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
9915 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
9916 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
9917
9918 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
9919 {
9920 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
9921 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
9922 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
9923 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
9924 }
9925 }
9926
9927 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at PC. */
9928
9929 static int
9930 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
9931 {
9932 int i;
9933
9934 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
9935 {
9936 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
9937 if (bp_tgt
9938 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
9939 bp_tgt->placed_address,
9940 aspace, pc))
9941 return 1;
9942 }
9943
9944 return 0;
9945 }
9946
9947 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
9948 non-zero otherwise. */
9949 static int
9950 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
9951 {
9952 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
9953 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
9954 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
9955 return 1;
9956 else
9957 return 0;
9958 }
9959
9960 int
9961 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
9962 {
9963 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
9964
9965 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
9966 }
9967
9968 int
9969 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
9970 {
9971 struct breakpoint *bp;
9972
9973 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
9974 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
9975 {
9976 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
9977 {
9978 int i, iter;
9979 for (i = 0;
9980 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
9981 i++)
9982 if (syscall_number == iter)
9983 return 1;
9984 }
9985 else
9986 return 1;
9987 }
9988
9989 return 0;
9990 }
9991
9992 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
9993 static char **
9994 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
9995 char *text, char *word)
9996 {
9997 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
9998 return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
9999 }
10000
10001 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
10002
10003 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
10004 static void
10005 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
10006 {
10007 tracepoint_count = num;
10008 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
10009 }
10010
10011 void
10012 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10013 {
10014 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10015 arg,
10016 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10017 0 /* tempflag */, 0 /* hardwareflag */,
10018 1 /* traceflag */,
10019 0 /* Ignore count */,
10020 pending_break_support,
10021 NULL,
10022 from_tty,
10023 1 /* enabled */))
10024 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10025 }
10026
10027 void
10028 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10029 {
10030 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10031 arg,
10032 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10033 0 /* tempflag */, 1 /* hardwareflag */,
10034 1 /* traceflag */,
10035 0 /* Ignore count */,
10036 pending_break_support,
10037 NULL,
10038 from_tty,
10039 1 /* enabled */))
10040 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10041 }
10042
10043 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
10044 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
10045 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
10046 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
10047 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
10048
10049 struct breakpoint *
10050 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
10051 {
10052 char buf[100];
10053 struct breakpoint *tp;
10054
10055 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw address. */
10056 sprintf (buf, "*%s", paddress (get_current_arch(), utp->addr));
10057
10058 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10059 buf,
10060 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
10061 0 /* tempflag */,
10062 (utp->type == bp_fast_tracepoint) /* hardwareflag */,
10063 1 /* traceflag */,
10064 0 /* Ignore count */,
10065 pending_break_support,
10066 NULL,
10067 0 /* from_tty */,
10068 utp->enabled /* enabled */))
10069 return NULL;
10070
10071 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
10072
10073 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
10074 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
10075
10076 if (utp->pass > 0)
10077 {
10078 sprintf (buf, "%d %d", utp->pass, tp->number);
10079
10080 trace_pass_command (buf, 0);
10081 }
10082
10083 if (utp->cond)
10084 {
10085 printf_filtered ("Want to restore a condition\n");
10086 }
10087
10088 if (utp->numactions > 0)
10089 {
10090 printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
10091 }
10092
10093 if (utp->num_step_actions > 0)
10094 {
10095 printf_filtered ("Want to restore action list\n");
10096 }
10097
10098 return tp;
10099 }
10100
10101 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
10102 omitted. */
10103
10104 static void
10105 tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
10106 {
10107 struct breakpoint *b;
10108 int tps_to_list = 0;
10109
10110 /* In the no-arguments case, say "No tracepoints" if none found. */
10111 if (tpnum_exp == 0)
10112 {
10113 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
10114 {
10115 if (b->number >= 0)
10116 {
10117 tps_to_list = 1;
10118 break;
10119 }
10120 }
10121 if (!tps_to_list)
10122 {
10123 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
10124 return;
10125 }
10126 }
10127
10128 /* Otherwise be the same as "info break". */
10129 breakpoints_info (tpnum_exp, from_tty);
10130 }
10131
10132 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
10133 Not supported by all targets. */
10134 static void
10135 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10136 {
10137 enable_command (args, from_tty);
10138 }
10139
10140 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
10141 Not supported by all targets. */
10142 static void
10143 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10144 {
10145 disable_command (args, from_tty);
10146 }
10147
10148 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument) */
10149 static void
10150 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10151 {
10152 struct breakpoint *b, *temp;
10153
10154 dont_repeat ();
10155
10156 if (arg == 0)
10157 {
10158 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
10159
10160 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
10161 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
10162 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
10163 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
10164 {
10165 if (b->number >= 0)
10166 {
10167 breaks_to_delete = 1;
10168 break;
10169 }
10170 }
10171
10172 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
10173 if (!from_tty
10174 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
10175 {
10176 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, temp)
10177 {
10178 if (tracepoint_type (b)
10179 && b->number >= 0)
10180 delete_breakpoint (b);
10181 }
10182 }
10183 }
10184 else
10185 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, delete_breakpoint);
10186 }
10187
10188 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
10189
10190 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
10191 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
10192 Also accepts special argument "all". */
10193
10194 static void
10195 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10196 {
10197 struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
10198 unsigned int count;
10199 int all = 0;
10200
10201 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
10202 error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
10203
10204 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
10205
10206 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
10207 args++;
10208
10209 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
10210 {
10211 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
10212 all = 1;
10213 if (*args)
10214 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
10215 }
10216 else
10217 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
10218
10219 do
10220 {
10221 if (t1)
10222 {
10223 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
10224 if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
10225 {
10226 t2->pass_count = count;
10227 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
10228 if (from_tty)
10229 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
10230 t2->number, count);
10231 }
10232 if (! all && *args)
10233 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
10234 }
10235 }
10236 while (*args);
10237 }
10238
10239 struct breakpoint *
10240 get_tracepoint (int num)
10241 {
10242 struct breakpoint *t;
10243
10244 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10245 if (t->number == num)
10246 return t;
10247
10248 return NULL;
10249 }
10250
10251 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
10252 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
10253 reconnecting). */
10254
10255 struct breakpoint *
10256 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
10257 {
10258 struct breakpoint *t;
10259
10260 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10261 if (t->number_on_target == num)
10262 return t;
10263
10264 return NULL;
10265 }
10266
10267 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
10268 If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
10269 if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
10270 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
10271 struct breakpoint *
10272 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
10273 {
10274 extern int tracepoint_count;
10275 struct breakpoint *t;
10276 int tpnum;
10277 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
10278
10279 if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
10280 {
10281 if (optional_p)
10282 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
10283 else
10284 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
10285 }
10286 else
10287 tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
10288
10289 if (tpnum <= 0)
10290 {
10291 if (instring && *instring)
10292 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
10293 instring);
10294 else
10295 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
10296 return NULL;
10297 }
10298
10299 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
10300 if (t->number == tpnum)
10301 {
10302 return t;
10303 }
10304
10305 /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
10306 a message. The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
10307 allow us to discover this. */
10308 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
10309 return NULL;
10310 }
10311
10312 /* save-tracepoints command */
10313 static void
10314 tracepoint_save_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10315 {
10316 struct breakpoint *tp;
10317 int any_tp = 0;
10318 struct action_line *line;
10319 FILE *fp;
10320 char *i1 = " ", *i2 = " ";
10321 char *indent, *actionline, *pathname;
10322 char tmp[40];
10323 struct cleanup *cleanup;
10324
10325 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
10326 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save tracepoints)"));
10327
10328 /* See if we have anything to save. */
10329 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10330 {
10331 any_tp = 1;
10332 break;
10333 }
10334 if (!any_tp)
10335 {
10336 warning (_("save-tracepoints: no tracepoints to save."));
10337 return;
10338 }
10339
10340 pathname = tilde_expand (args);
10341 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
10342 fp = fopen (pathname, "w");
10343 if (!fp)
10344 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving tracepoints (%s)"),
10345 args, safe_strerror (errno));
10346 make_cleanup_fclose (fp);
10347
10348 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10349 {
10350 if (tp->addr_string)
10351 fprintf (fp, "trace %s\n", tp->addr_string);
10352 else
10353 {
10354 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
10355 fprintf (fp, "trace *0x%s\n", tmp);
10356 }
10357
10358 if (tp->pass_count)
10359 fprintf (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
10360
10361 if (tp->actions)
10362 {
10363 fprintf (fp, " actions\n");
10364 indent = i1;
10365 for (line = tp->actions; line; line = line->next)
10366 {
10367 struct cmd_list_element *cmd;
10368
10369 QUIT; /* allow user to bail out with ^C */
10370 actionline = line->action;
10371 while (isspace ((int) *actionline))
10372 actionline++;
10373
10374 fprintf (fp, "%s%s\n", indent, actionline);
10375 if (*actionline != '#') /* skip for comment lines */
10376 {
10377 cmd = lookup_cmd (&actionline, cmdlist, "", -1, 1);
10378 if (cmd == 0)
10379 error (_("Bad action list item: %s"), actionline);
10380 if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, while_stepping_pseudocommand))
10381 indent = i2;
10382 else if (cmd_cfunc_eq (cmd, end_actions_pseudocommand))
10383 indent = i1;
10384 }
10385 }
10386 }
10387 }
10388 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10389 if (from_tty)
10390 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoints saved to file '%s'.\n"), args);
10391 return;
10392 }
10393
10394 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
10395
10396 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
10397 all_tracepoints ()
10398 {
10399 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
10400 struct breakpoint *tp;
10401
10402 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
10403 {
10404 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
10405 }
10406
10407 return tp_vec;
10408 }
10409
10410 \f
10411 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak commands.
10412 It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
10413 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the command. */
10414 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
10415 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
10416 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10417 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
10418 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
10419 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
10420 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of selected stack frame.\n\
10421 This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
10422 \n\
10423 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
10424 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
10425 \n\
10426 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if conditional.\n\
10427 \n\
10428 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
10429
10430 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
10431 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
10432
10433 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
10434 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
10435
10436 /* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
10437 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
10438 static void
10439 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
10440 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
10441 struct cmd_list_element *command),
10442 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
10443 char *text, char *word),
10444 void *user_data_catch,
10445 void *user_data_tcatch)
10446 {
10447 struct cmd_list_element *command;
10448
10449 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10450 &catch_cmdlist);
10451 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10452 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
10453 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10454
10455 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
10456 &tcatch_cmdlist);
10457 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
10458 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
10459 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
10460 }
10461
10462 static void
10463 clear_syscall_counts (struct inferior *inf)
10464 {
10465 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
10466 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
10467 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
10468 }
10469
10470 void
10471 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
10472 {
10473 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
10474 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
10475 struct cmd_list_element *c;
10476
10477 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
10478 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
10479 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
10480
10481 breakpoint_chain = 0;
10482 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
10483 before a breakpoint is set. */
10484 breakpoint_count = 0;
10485
10486 tracepoint_count = 0;
10487
10488 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
10489 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
10490 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
10491 if (xdb_commands)
10492 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
10493
10494 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
10495 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
10496 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
10497 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
10498 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
10499 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
10500 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
10501 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
10502
10503 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
10504 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
10505 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
10506 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
10507
10508 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
10509 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
10510 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10511 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
10512 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
10513 \n"
10514 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
10515 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10516
10517 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
10518 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10519 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
10520 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
10521 \n"
10522 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
10523 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10524
10525 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
10526 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
10527 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
10528 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
10529 \n"
10530 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
10531 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10532
10533 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10534 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10535 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10536 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10537 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10538 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
10539 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10540 if (xdb_commands)
10541 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10542 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10543 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10544 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
10545 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10546 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
10547
10548 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10549
10550 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
10551 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
10552 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
10553 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
10554 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
10555 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
10556
10557 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10558 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10559 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10560 &enablebreaklist);
10561
10562 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10563 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10564 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10565 &enablebreaklist);
10566
10567 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
10568 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10569 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
10570 &enablelist);
10571
10572 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
10573 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
10574 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
10575 &enablelist);
10576
10577 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10578 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10579 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10580 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10581 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
10582 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
10583 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10584 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
10585 if (xdb_commands)
10586 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
10587 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10588 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10589 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10590 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
10591
10592 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
10593 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
10594 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10595 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10596 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
10597 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
10598 &disablelist);
10599
10600 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10601 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10602 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10603 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10604 \n\
10605 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
10606 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
10607 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
10608 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10609 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
10610 if (xdb_commands)
10611 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
10612 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
10613 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10614 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
10615
10616 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
10617 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
10618 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
10619 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
10620 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
10621 &deletelist);
10622
10623 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
10624 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
10625 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
10626 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
10627 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
10628 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
10629 \n\
10630 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
10631 is executing in.\n\
10632 \n\
10633 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
10634
10635 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
10636 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
10637 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
10638 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10639
10640 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
10641 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
10642 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
10643 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
10644
10645 if (xdb_commands)
10646 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
10647
10648 if (dbx_commands)
10649 {
10650 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
10651 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
10652 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
10653 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
10654 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
10655 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
10656 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
10657 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
10658 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10659 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10660 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10661 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10662 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10663 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10664 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10665 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10666 \n\
10667 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10668 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10669 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10670 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10671 breakpoint set."));
10672 }
10673
10674 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
10675 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10676 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10677 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10678 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10679 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10680 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10681 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10682 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10683 \n\
10684 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10685 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10686 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10687 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10688 breakpoint set."));
10689
10690 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
10691
10692 if (xdb_commands)
10693 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
10694 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10695 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10696 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10697 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10698 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10699 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10700 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10701 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10702 \n\
10703 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10704 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10705 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10706 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10707 breakpoint set."));
10708
10709 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
10710 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
10711 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
10712 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
10713 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
10714 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
10715 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
10716 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
10717 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
10718 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
10719 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
10720 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
10721 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
10722 \n\
10723 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
10724 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
10725 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
10726 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
10727 breakpoint set."),
10728 &maintenanceinfolist);
10729
10730 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
10731 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
10732 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
10733 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10734
10735 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
10736 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
10737 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
10738 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
10739
10740 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
10741 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
10742 Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
10743 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10744 catch_catch_command,
10745 NULL,
10746 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10747 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10748 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
10749 Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
10750 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10751 catch_throw_command,
10752 NULL,
10753 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10754 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10755 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
10756 catch_fork_command_1,
10757 NULL,
10758 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
10759 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
10760 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
10761 catch_fork_command_1,
10762 NULL,
10763 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
10764 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
10765 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
10766 catch_exec_command_1,
10767 NULL,
10768 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10769 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10770 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
10771 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
10772 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
10773 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
10774 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
10775 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
10776 catch_syscall_command_1,
10777 catch_syscall_completer,
10778 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10779 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10780 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
10781 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
10782 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10783 catch_ada_exception_command,
10784 NULL,
10785 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10786 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10787 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
10788 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
10789 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
10790 catch_assert_command,
10791 NULL,
10792 CATCH_PERMANENT,
10793 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
10794
10795 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
10796 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10797 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10798 an expression changes."));
10799 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10800
10801 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
10802 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10803 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10804 an expression is read."));
10805 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10806
10807 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
10808 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
10809 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
10810 an expression is either read or written."));
10811 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
10812
10813 add_info ("watchpoints", breakpoints_info,
10814 _("Synonym for ``info breakpoints''."));
10815
10816
10817 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
10818 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
10819 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
10820 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
10821 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10822 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
10823 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
10824 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
10825 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
10826 hardware.)"),
10827 NULL,
10828 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
10829 &setlist, &showlist);
10830
10831 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
10832
10833 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
10834
10835 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
10836 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10837 \n"
10838 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
10839 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10840 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10841
10842 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
10843 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10844 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10845 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
10846
10847 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
10848 Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
10849 \n"
10850 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
10851 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
10852 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
10853
10854 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
10855 Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
10856 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
10857 last tracepoint set."));
10858
10859 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
10860
10861 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
10862 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
10863 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10864 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
10865 &deletelist);
10866
10867 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
10868 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
10869 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10870 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
10871 &disablelist);
10872 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
10873
10874 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
10875 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
10876 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
10877 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
10878 &enablelist);
10879 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
10880
10881 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
10882 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
10883 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
10884 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
10885 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
10886
10887 c = add_com ("save-tracepoints", class_trace, tracepoint_save_command, _("\
10888 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
10889 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."));
10890 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
10891
10892 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10893 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10894 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10895 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10896 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
10897 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
10898 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
10899 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
10900 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
10901 pending breakpoint behavior"),
10902 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
10903 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
10904
10905 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
10906 &pending_break_support, _("\
10907 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10908 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
10909 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
10910 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
10911 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
10912 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
10913 NULL,
10914 show_pending_break_support,
10915 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10916 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10917
10918 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
10919
10920 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
10921 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
10922 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10923 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
10924 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
10925 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
10926 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
10927 NULL,
10928 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
10929 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10930 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10931
10932 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
10933 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
10934 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10935 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
10936 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
10937 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
10938 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
10939 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
10940 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
10941 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
10942 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
10943 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
10944 NULL,
10945 &show_always_inserted_mode,
10946 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
10947 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
10948
10949 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
10950
10951 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
10952 }